2004-06-30 Andrew Stubbs <andrew.stubbs@superh.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
c552b3bb 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
9fe8321b 31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
e9c75b65 32@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c 33
87885426
FN
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 36
6c0e9fb3 37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 38
c906108c 39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 40@c manuals to an info tree.
03727ca6 41@dircategory Software development
96a2c332 42@direntry
03727ca6 43* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
96a2c332
SS
44@end direntry
45
c906108c
SS
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
9fe8321b
AC
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
c906108c 53
8a037dd7 54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
c552b3bb 55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 56
e9c75b65
EZ
57Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
60Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 63
6826cf00
EZ
64(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67development.''
c906108c
SS
68@end ifinfo
69
70@titlepage
71@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 73@sp 1
c906108c 74@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
b51970ac 871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
9fe8321b 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
c552b3bb 118Copyright (C) 1988-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 131* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 132* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 133* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
134
135* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138* Altering:: Altering execution
139* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 141* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 145* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
21c294e6 146* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
6d2ebf8b
SS
147* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 149* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
150
151* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 157* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 158* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
f418dd93 159* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
aab4e0ec
AC
160* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
161 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 162* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
163* Index:: Index
164@end menu
165
6c0e9fb3 166@end ifnottex
c906108c 167
449f3b6c 168@contents
449f3b6c 169
6d2ebf8b 170@node Summary
c906108c
SS
171@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
172
173The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
174going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
175program was doing at the moment it crashed.
176
177@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
178these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
179
180@itemize @bullet
181@item
182Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
183
184@item
185Make your program stop on specified conditions.
186
187@item
188Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
189
190@item
191Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
192effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
193@end itemize
194
49efadf5 195You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
c906108c 196For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
197For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
198
cce74817 199@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
200Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
201@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 202
cce74817
JM
203@cindex Pascal
204Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
205nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
206entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
207syntax.
c906108c 208
c906108c
SS
209@cindex Fortran
210@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 211it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 212underscore.
c906108c 213
b37303ee
AF
214@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
215using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
216
c906108c
SS
217@menu
218* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
219* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
220@end menu
221
6d2ebf8b 222@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
223@unnumberedsec Free software
224
5d161b24 225@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
226General Public License
227(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
228program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
229freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
230the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
231Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
232Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
233
234Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
235you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
236from anyone else.
237
2666264b 238@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
239
240The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
241the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
242include with the free software. Many of our most important
243programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
244texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
245when an important free software package does not come with a free
246manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
247gaps today.
248
249Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
250normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
251authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
252copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
253them from the free software world.
254
255That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
256from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
257manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
258only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
259contract to make it non-free.
260
261Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
262price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
263charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
264Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
265problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
266are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
267modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
268
269The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
270free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
271commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
272accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
273
274Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
275When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
276are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
277provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
278manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
279a changed version of the program is not really available to our
280community.
281
282Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
283acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
284author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
285authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
286to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
287may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
288with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
289are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
290of the manual.
291
292However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
293content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
294media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
295obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
296manual to replace it.
297
298Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
299lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
300free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
301the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
302realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
303the free software community.
304
305If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
306the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
307license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
308don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
309will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
310option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
311what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
312try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 313is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
314
315You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
316manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
317copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
318improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
319at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
320and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
321Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
322have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
323
324The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
325published by other publishers, at
326@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
327
6d2ebf8b 328@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
329@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
330
331Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
332other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
333development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
334of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
335to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
336file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
337blow-by-blow account.
338
339Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
340
341@quotation
342@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
343or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
344omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
345@end quotation
346
347So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
348particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
349releases:
faae5abe 350Andrew Cagney (releases 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
351Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
352Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
353Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
354Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
355Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
356John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
357Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
358and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
359
360Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
361Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
362
b37052ae
EZ
363Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
364in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
365Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
366demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
367much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 368
b37052ae 369@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
370object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
371Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
372
373David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
374the original support for encapsulated COFF.
375
0179ffac 376Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
c906108c
SS
377
378Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
379Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
380support.
381Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
382Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
383Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
384David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
385Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
386Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
387Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
388Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
389Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
390Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
391Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
392Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
393Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
394Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
395Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 396Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 397
1104b9e7 398Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
399
400Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401libraries.
402
403Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404about several machine instruction sets.
405
406Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412command-line editing and command history.
413
7a292a7a
SS
414Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 416
5d161b24 417Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 418He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 419symbols.
c906108c 420
f24c5e49
KI
421Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
422H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
c906108c
SS
423
424NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
f24c5e49
KI
426Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
427processors.
c906108c
SS
428
429Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
430
431Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
432
96a2c332 433Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
434
435Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
436watchpoints.
437
438Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
439
440Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
441
442Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 443nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
444
445The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
446support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 447(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
d0d5df6f
AC
448compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
449Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
450Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
451provided HP-specific information in this manual.
c906108c 452
b37052ae
EZ
453DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
454Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
455
96a2c332
SS
456Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
457development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
458fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
459Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
460Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
461Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
462Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
463addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
464JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
465Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
466Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
467Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
468Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
469Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
470Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 471
e2e0bcd1
JB
472Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
473Hat.
c906108c 474
6d2ebf8b 475@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
476@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
477
478You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
479However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
480debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
481
482@iftex
483In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
484to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
485@end iftex
486
487@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
488@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
489
490One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
491processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
492quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
493definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
494session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
495then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
496same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
497@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
498procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
499
500@smallexample
501$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
502$ @b{./m4}
503@b{define(foo,0000)}
504
505@b{foo}
5060000
507@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
508
509@b{bar}
5100000
511@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
512
513@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
514@b{baz}
515@b{C-d}
516m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
517@end smallexample
518
519@noindent
520Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
521
c906108c
SS
522@smallexample
523$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
524@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
525@c FIXME... format to come out better.
526@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 527 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 528 the conditions.
5d161b24 529There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
530 for details.
531
532@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
533(@value{GDBP})
534@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
535
536@noindent
537@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
538rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
539We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
540that examples fit in this manual.
541
542@smallexample
543(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
544@end smallexample
545
546@noindent
547We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
548Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
549@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
550@code{break} command.
551
552@smallexample
553(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
554Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
555@end smallexample
556
557@noindent
558Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
559control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
560subroutine, the program runs as usual:
561
562@smallexample
563(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
564Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
565@b{define(foo,0000)}
566
567@b{foo}
5680000
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
573suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
574context where it stops.
575
576@smallexample
577@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
578
5d161b24 579Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
580 at builtin.c:879
581879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
582@end smallexample
583
584@noindent
585Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
586the next line of the current function.
587
588@smallexample
589(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
590882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
591 : nil,
592@end smallexample
593
594@noindent
595@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
596by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
597@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
598subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
599
600@smallexample
601(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
602set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
603 at input.c:530
604530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
605@end smallexample
606
607@noindent
608The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
609suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
610shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
611command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
612in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
613stack frame for each active subroutine.
614
615@smallexample
616(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
617#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
618 at input.c:530
5d161b24 619#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
620 at builtin.c:882
621#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
622#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
623 at macro.c:71
624#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
625#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
626@end smallexample
627
628@noindent
629We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
630times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
631falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
632
633@smallexample
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6350x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6370x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
638def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
641 : xstrdup(rq);
642(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
643538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
644@end smallexample
645
646@noindent
647The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
648@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
649and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
650(@code{print}) to see their values.
651
652@smallexample
653(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
654$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
655(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
656$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
657@end smallexample
658
659@noindent
660@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
661To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
662surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
663
664@smallexample
665(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
666533 xfree(rquote);
667534
668535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
669 : xstrdup (lq);
670536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
671 : xstrdup (rq);
672537
673538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
674539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
675540 @}
676541
677542 void
678@end smallexample
679
680@noindent
681Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
682@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
686539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688540 @}
689(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
690$3 = 9
691(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
692$4 = 7
693@end smallexample
694
695@noindent
696That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
697@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
698@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
699the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
700any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
701assignments.
702
703@smallexample
704(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
705$5 = 7
706(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
707$6 = 9
708@end smallexample
709
710@noindent
711Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
712@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
713executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
714example that caused trouble initially:
715
716@smallexample
717(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
718Continuing.
719
720@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
721
722baz
7230000
724@end smallexample
725
726@noindent
727Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
728problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
729lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
730
731@smallexample
732@b{C-d}
733Program exited normally.
734@end smallexample
735
736@noindent
737The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
738indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
739session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
740
741@smallexample
742(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
743@end smallexample
c906108c 744
6d2ebf8b 745@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
746@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
747
748This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 749The essentials are:
c906108c 750@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 751@item
53a5351d 752type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 753@item
c906108c
SS
754type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
755@end itemize
756
757@menu
758* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
759* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
760* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
0fac0b41 761* Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
c906108c
SS
762@end menu
763
6d2ebf8b 764@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
765@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
766
c906108c
SS
767Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
768@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
769
770You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
771to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
772
c906108c
SS
773The command-line options described here are designed
774to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 775options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
776
777The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
778specifying an executable program:
779
474c8240 780@smallexample
c906108c 781@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 782@end smallexample
c906108c 783
c906108c
SS
784@noindent
785You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
786specified:
787
474c8240 788@smallexample
c906108c 789@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 790@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
791
792You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
793to debug a running process:
794
474c8240 795@smallexample
c906108c 796@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 797@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
798
799@noindent
800would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
801named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
802
c906108c 803Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
804complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
805debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
806``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
807will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 808
aa26fa3a
TT
809You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
810executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
811option processing.
474c8240 812@smallexample
aa26fa3a 813gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 814@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
815This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
816@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
817
96a2c332 818You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
819@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
820
821@smallexample
822@value{GDBP} -silent
823@end smallexample
824
825@noindent
826You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
827options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
828
829@noindent
830Type
831
474c8240 832@smallexample
c906108c 833@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 834@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
835
836@noindent
837to display all available options and briefly describe their use
838(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
839
840All options and command line arguments you give are processed
841in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
842@samp{-x} option is used.
843
844
845@menu
c906108c
SS
846* File Options:: Choosing files
847* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
848@end menu
849
6d2ebf8b 850@node File Options
c906108c
SS
851@subsection Choosing files
852
2df3850c 853When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
854specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
855the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
856@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
857first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
858equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
859second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
860equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
861If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
862first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
863to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
b383017d 864a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 865prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
866
867If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
868such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
869argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
870
871Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
872following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
873them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
874(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
875than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
876
d700128c
EZ
877@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
878@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
879@c it.
880
c906108c
SS
881@table @code
882@item -symbols @var{file}
883@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
884@cindex @code{--symbols}
885@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
886Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
887
888@item -exec @var{file}
889@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
890@cindex @code{--exec}
891@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
892Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
893and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
894
895@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 896@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
897Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
898file.
899
c906108c
SS
900@item -core @var{file}
901@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
902@cindex @code{--core}
903@cindex @code{-c}
b383017d 904Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
905
906@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
907@item -pid @var{number}
908@itemx -p @var{number}
909@cindex @code{--pid}
910@cindex @code{-p}
911Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
912If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
913file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
914
915@item -command @var{file}
916@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
917@cindex @code{--command}
918@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
919Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
920Files,, Command files}.
921
922@item -directory @var{directory}
923@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
924@cindex @code{--directory}
925@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
926Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
927
c906108c
SS
928@item -m
929@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
930@cindex @code{--mapped}
931@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
932@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
933supported on all systems.}@*
934If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 935system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
936to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
937program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 938called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
939Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
940and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
941the symbol table from the executable program.
942
943The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
944is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
945table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 946
c906108c
SS
947@item -r
948@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
949@cindex @code{--readnow}
950@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
951Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
952the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
953This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 954
c906108c
SS
955@end table
956
2df3850c 957You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 958order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
959information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
960on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
961but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 962
474c8240 963@smallexample
2df3850c 964gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 965@end smallexample
c906108c 966
6d2ebf8b 967@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
968@subsection Choosing modes
969
970You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
971batch mode or quiet mode.
972
973@table @code
974@item -nx
975@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
976@cindex @code{--nx}
977@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 978Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
979@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
980options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
981files}.
c906108c
SS
982
983@item -quiet
d700128c 984@itemx -silent
c906108c 985@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
986@cindex @code{--quiet}
987@cindex @code{--silent}
988@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
989``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
990messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
991
992@item -batch
d700128c 993@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
994Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
995command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
996initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
997nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
998in the command files.
999
2df3850c
JM
1000Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1001example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1002make this more useful, the message
c906108c 1003
474c8240 1004@smallexample
c906108c 1005Program exited normally.
474c8240 1006@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1007
1008@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1009(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1010@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1011mode.
1012
1013@item -nowindows
1014@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1015@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1016@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1017``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1018(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1019interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1020
1021@item -windows
1022@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1023@cindex @code{--windows}
1024@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1025If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1026used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1027
1028@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1029@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1030Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1031instead of the current directory.
1032
c906108c
SS
1033@item -fullname
1034@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1035@cindex @code{--fullname}
1036@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1037@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1038subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1039number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1040displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1041recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1042the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1043and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1044@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1045frame.
c906108c 1046
d700128c
EZ
1047@item -epoch
1048@cindex @code{--epoch}
1049The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1050@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1051routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1052separate window.
1053
1054@item -annotate @var{level}
1055@cindex @code{--annotate}
1056This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1057effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
086432e2
AC
1058(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1059information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1060expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1061normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1062@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1063that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1064
1065The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1066(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
d700128c
EZ
1067
1068@item -async
1069@cindex @code{--async}
1070Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1071@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1072special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1073commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1074run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1075MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1076suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1077control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1078(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1079operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1080yet.)
1081@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1082@c should be removed.
1083
1084When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1085uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1086@samp{-noasync} option.
1087
1088@item -noasync
1089@cindex @code{--noasync}
1090Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1091
aa26fa3a
TT
1092@item --args
1093@cindex @code{--args}
1094Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1095executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1096This option stops option processing.
1097
2df3850c
JM
1098@item -baud @var{bps}
1099@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1100@cindex @code{--baud}
1101@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1102Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1103interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1104
1105@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1106@itemx -t @var{device}
1107@cindex @code{--tty}
1108@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1109Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1110@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1111
53a5351d 1112@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1113@item -tui
1114@cindex @code{--tui}
d0d5df6f
AC
1115Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1116Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1117source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1118(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1119Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1120@samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1121Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1122
1123@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1124@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1125@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1126@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1127@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1128@c systems.
1129
d700128c
EZ
1130@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1131@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1132Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1133program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0 1134communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
21c294e6 1135@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
94bbb2c0 1136
da0f9dcd 1137@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
2fcf52f0 1138@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
6c74ac8b
AC
1139The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @var{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1140previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1141selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1142@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
d700128c
EZ
1143
1144@item -write
1145@cindex @code{--write}
1146Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1147is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1148(@pxref{Patching}).
1149
1150@item -statistics
1151@cindex @code{--statistics}
1152This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1153memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1154
1155@item -version
1156@cindex @code{--version}
1157This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1158no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1159
c906108c
SS
1160@end table
1161
6d2ebf8b 1162@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1163@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1164@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1165@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1166
1167@table @code
1168@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1169@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1170@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1171@itemx q
1172To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1173@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1174do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1175otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1176error code.
c906108c
SS
1177@end table
1178
1179@cindex interrupt
1180An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1181terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1182returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1183character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1184until a time when it is safe.
1185
c906108c
SS
1186If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1187device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1188(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1189
6d2ebf8b 1190@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1191@section Shell commands
1192
1193If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1194debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1195just use the @code{shell} command.
1196
1197@table @code
1198@kindex shell
1199@cindex shell escape
1200@item shell @var{command string}
1201Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1202If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1203shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1204(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1205@end table
1206
1207The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1208You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1209@value{GDBN}:
1210
1211@table @code
1212@kindex make
1213@cindex calling make
1214@item make @var{make-args}
1215Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1216arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1217@end table
1218
0fac0b41
DJ
1219@node Logging output
1220@section Logging output
1221@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1222
1223You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1224There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1225
1226@table @code
1227@kindex set logging
1228@item set logging on
1229Enable logging.
1230@item set logging off
1231Disable logging.
1232@item set logging file @var{file}
1233Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1234@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1235By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1236you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1237@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1238By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1239Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1240@kindex show logging
1241@item show logging
1242Show the current values of the logging settings.
1243@end table
1244
6d2ebf8b 1245@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1246@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1247
1248You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1249name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1250@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1251key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1252show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1253
1254@menu
1255* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1256* Completion:: Command completion
1257* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1258@end menu
1259
6d2ebf8b 1260@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1261@section Command syntax
1262
1263A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1264how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1265arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1266command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1267step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1268with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1269
1270@cindex abbreviation
1271@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1272unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1273documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1274abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1275equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1276names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1277arguments to the @code{help} command.
1278
1279@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1280@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1281A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1282repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1283will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1284repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1285repeat.
1286
1287The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1288@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1289exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1290
1291@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1292output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1293(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1294@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1295repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1296
41afff9a 1297@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1298@cindex comment
1299Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1300nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1301Files,,Command files}).
1302
88118b3a
TT
1303@cindex repeating command sequences
1304@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1305The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1306commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1307then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1308for editing.
1309
6d2ebf8b 1310@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1311@section Command completion
1312
1313@cindex completion
1314@cindex word completion
1315@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1316only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1317are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1318commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1319
1320Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1321of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1322word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1323enter it). For example, if you type
1324
1325@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1326@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1327@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1328@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1329@smallexample
c906108c 1330(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1331@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1332
1333@noindent
1334@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1335the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1336
474c8240 1337@smallexample
c906108c 1338(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1339@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1340
1341@noindent
1342You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1343breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1344@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1345were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1346might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1347to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1348
1349If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1350@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1351characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1352@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1353example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1354begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1355just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1356function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1357example:
1358
474c8240 1359@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1360(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1361@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1362make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1363make_abs_section make_function_type
1364make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1365make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1366make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1367(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1368@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1369
1370@noindent
1371After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1372partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1373command.
1374
1375If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1376can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1377means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1378key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1379one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1380
1381@cindex quotes in commands
1382@cindex completion of quoted strings
1383Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1384parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1385its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1386situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1387@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1388
c906108c 1389The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1390name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1391overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1392by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1393may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1394that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1395that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1396word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1397@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1398@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1399when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1400
474c8240 1401@smallexample
96a2c332 1402(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1403bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1404(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1405@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1406
1407In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1408quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1409completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1410place:
1411
474c8240 1412@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1413(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1414@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1415(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1416@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1417
1418@noindent
1419In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1420you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1421completion on an overloaded symbol.
1422
d4f3574e 1423For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1424expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1425overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1426see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1427
1428
6d2ebf8b 1429@node Help
c906108c
SS
1430@section Getting help
1431@cindex online documentation
1432@kindex help
1433
5d161b24 1434You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1435using the command @code{help}.
1436
1437@table @code
41afff9a 1438@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1439@item help
1440@itemx h
1441You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1442display a short list of named classes of commands:
1443
1444@smallexample
1445(@value{GDBP}) help
1446List of classes of commands:
1447
2df3850c 1448aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1449breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1450data -- Examining data
c906108c 1451files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1452internals -- Maintenance commands
1453obscure -- Obscure features
1454running -- Running the program
1455stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1456status -- Status inquiries
1457support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1458tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1459 stopping the program
c906108c 1460user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1461
5d161b24 1462Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1463commands in that class.
5d161b24 1464Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1465documentation.
1466Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1467(@value{GDBP})
1468@end smallexample
96a2c332 1469@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1470
1471@item help @var{class}
1472Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1473list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1474help display for the class @code{status}:
1475
1476@smallexample
1477(@value{GDBP}) help status
1478Status inquiries.
1479
1480List of commands:
1481
1482@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1483@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1484info -- Generic command for showing things
1485 about the program being debugged
1486show -- Generic command for showing things
1487 about the debugger
c906108c 1488
5d161b24 1489Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1490documentation.
1491Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1492(@value{GDBP})
1493@end smallexample
1494
1495@item help @var{command}
1496With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1497short paragraph on how to use that command.
1498
6837a0a2
DB
1499@kindex apropos
1500@item apropos @var{args}
1501The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1502commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1503@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1504
1505@smallexample
1506apropos reload
1507@end smallexample
1508
b37052ae
EZ
1509@noindent
1510results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1511
1512@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1513@c @group
1514set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1515 multiple times in one run
1516show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1517 multiple times in one run
1518@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1519@end smallexample
1520
c906108c
SS
1521@kindex complete
1522@item complete @var{args}
1523The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1524for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1525command you want completed. For example:
1526
1527@smallexample
1528complete i
1529@end smallexample
1530
1531@noindent results in:
1532
1533@smallexample
1534@group
2df3850c
JM
1535if
1536ignore
c906108c
SS
1537info
1538inspect
c906108c
SS
1539@end group
1540@end smallexample
1541
1542@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1543@end table
1544
1545In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1546and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1547of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1548manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1549under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1550all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1551
1552@c @group
1553@table @code
1554@kindex info
41afff9a 1555@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1556@item info
1557This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1558program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1559with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1560registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1561You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1562@w{@code{help info}}.
1563
1564@kindex set
1565@item set
5d161b24 1566You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1567@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1568@code{set prompt $}.
1569
1570@kindex show
1571@item show
5d161b24 1572In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1573@value{GDBN} itself.
1574You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1575related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1576system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1577which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1578
1579@kindex info set
1580To display all the settable parameters and their current
1581values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1582@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1583@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1584@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1585@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1586@end table
1587@c @end group
1588
1589Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1590exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1591
1592@table @code
1593@kindex show version
1594@cindex version number
1595@item show version
1596Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1597information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1598@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1599version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1600commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1601system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1602variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1603The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1604@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1605
1606@kindex show copying
1607@item show copying
1608Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1609
1610@kindex show warranty
1611@item show warranty
2df3850c 1612Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1613if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1614
c906108c
SS
1615@end table
1616
6d2ebf8b 1617@node Running
c906108c
SS
1618@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1619
1620When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1621debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1622
1623You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1624of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1625your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1626kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1627
1628@menu
1629* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1630* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1631* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1632* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1633
1634* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1635* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1636* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1637* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1638
1639* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1640* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1641@end menu
1642
6d2ebf8b 1643@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1644@section Compiling for debugging
1645
1646In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1647debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1648is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1649variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1650and addresses in the executable code.
1651
1652To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1653the compiler.
1654
e2e0bcd1
JB
1655Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1656the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1657because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1658the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1659options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1660debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1661``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1662to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1663@option{-g} alone.
1664
c906108c
SS
1665Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1666options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1667executables containing debugging information.
1668
53a5351d
JM
1669@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1670without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1671recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1672program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1673in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@cindex optimized code, debugging
1676@cindex debugging optimized code
1677When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1678optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1679really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1680exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1681variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1682variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1683
1684Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1685@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1686doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1687please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1688
1689Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1690@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1691format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1692
1693@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1694@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1695@section Starting your program
1696@cindex starting
1697@cindex running
1698
1699@table @code
1700@kindex run
41afff9a 1701@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1702@item run
1703@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1704Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1705You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1706argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1707@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1708(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1709
1710@end table
1711
c906108c
SS
1712If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1713supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1714that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1715@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1716
1717The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1718receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1719information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1720can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1721your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1722divided into four categories:
1723
1724@table @asis
1725@item The @emph{arguments.}
1726Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1727@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1728is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1729(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1730the arguments.
1731In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1732@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1733@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1734
1735@item The @emph{environment.}
1736Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1737use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1738environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1739your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1740
1741@item The @emph{working directory.}
1742Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1743the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1744@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1745
1746@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1747Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1748standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1749in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1750set a different device for your program.
1751@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1752
1753@cindex pipes
1754@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1755pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1756program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1757wrong program.
1758@end table
c906108c
SS
1759
1760When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1761immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1762of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1763stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1764or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1765
1766If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1767time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1768table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1769your current breakpoints.
1770
4e8b0763
JB
1771@table @code
1772@kindex start
1773@item start
1774@cindex run to main procedure
1775The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1776With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1777other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1778main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1779execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1780procedure, depending on the language used.
1781
1782The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1783breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1784the @samp{run} command.
1785
1786Some programs contain an elaboration phase where some startup code is
1787executed before the main program is called. This depends on the
1788languages used to write your program. In C@t{++} for instance,
1789constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1790@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1791before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1792will remain to halt execution.
1793
1794Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1795@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1796underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1797reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1798@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1799
1800It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1801these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1802your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1803elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1804elaboration code before running your program.
1805@end table
1806
6d2ebf8b 1807@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1808@section Your program's arguments
1809
1810@cindex arguments (to your program)
1811The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1812@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1813They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1814performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1815@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1816@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1817the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1818
1819On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1820@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1821calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1822the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1823
1824@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1825@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1826
c906108c 1827@table @code
41afff9a 1828@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1829@item set args
1830Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1831@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1832with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1833using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1834it again without arguments.
1835
1836@kindex show args
1837@item show args
1838Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1839@end table
1840
6d2ebf8b 1841@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1842@section Your program's environment
1843
1844@cindex environment (of your program)
1845The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1846their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1847your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1848path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1849the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1850debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1851environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1852
1853@table @code
1854@kindex path
1855@item path @var{directory}
1856Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1857(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1858The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1859You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1860system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1861MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1862is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1863
1864You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1865working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1866use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1867@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1868@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1869@var{directory} to the search path.
1870@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1871@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1872
1873@kindex show paths
1874@item show paths
1875Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1876environment variable).
1877
1878@kindex show environment
1879@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1880Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1881your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1882print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1883your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1884
1885@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1886@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1887Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1888changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1889be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1890any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1891parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1892null value.
1893@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1894@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1895
1896For example, this command:
1897
474c8240 1898@smallexample
c906108c 1899set env USER = foo
474c8240 1900@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1901
1902@noindent
d4f3574e 1903tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1904@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1905are not actually required.)
1906
1907@kindex unset environment
1908@item unset environment @var{varname}
1909Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1910program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1911@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1912rather than assigning it an empty value.
1913@end table
1914
d4f3574e
SS
1915@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1916the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1917by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1918@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1919that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1920@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1921your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1922files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1923@file{.profile}.
1924
6d2ebf8b 1925@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1926@section Your program's working directory
1927
1928@cindex working directory (of your program)
1929Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1930working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1931The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1932from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1933working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1934
1935The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1936that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1937specify files}.
1938
1939@table @code
1940@kindex cd
1941@item cd @var{directory}
1942Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1943
1944@kindex pwd
1945@item pwd
1946Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1947@end table
1948
6d2ebf8b 1949@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1950@section Your program's input and output
1951
1952@cindex redirection
1953@cindex i/o
1954@cindex terminal
1955By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1956the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1957to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1958modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1959running your program.
1960
1961@table @code
1962@kindex info terminal
1963@item info terminal
1964Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1965program is using.
1966@end table
1967
1968You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1969redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1970
474c8240 1971@smallexample
c906108c 1972run > outfile
474c8240 1973@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1974
1975@noindent
1976starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1977
1978@kindex tty
1979@cindex controlling terminal
1980Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1981with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1982argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1983commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1984process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1985
474c8240 1986@smallexample
c906108c 1987tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1988@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1989
1990@noindent
1991directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1992default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1993that as their controlling terminal.
1994
1995An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1996effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1997terminal.
1998
1999When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2000command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2001for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
2002
6d2ebf8b 2003@node Attach
c906108c
SS
2004@section Debugging an already-running process
2005@kindex attach
2006@cindex attach
2007
2008@table @code
2009@item attach @var{process-id}
2010This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2011outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2012targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2013find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2014or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2015
2016@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2017executing the command.
2018@end table
2019
2020To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2021which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2022programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2023also have permission to send the process a signal.
2024
2025When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2026the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2027the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2028(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2029the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2030Specify Files}.
2031
2032The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2033process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
2034with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2035you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2036can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2037process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
2038attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2039
2040@table @code
2041@kindex detach
2042@item detach
2043When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2044@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2045the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2046that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2047are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2048@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2049executing the command.
2050@end table
2051
2052If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2053attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2054for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2055control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2056confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2057messages}).
2058
6d2ebf8b 2059@node Kill Process
c906108c 2060@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
2061
2062@table @code
2063@kindex kill
2064@item kill
2065Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2066@end table
2067
2068This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2069running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2070is running.
2071
2072On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2073while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2074@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2075outside the debugger.
2076
2077The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2078relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2079executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2080next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2081reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2082breakpoint settings).
2083
6d2ebf8b 2084@node Threads
c906108c 2085@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2086
2087@cindex threads of execution
2088@cindex multiple threads
2089@cindex switching threads
2090In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2091may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2092of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2093the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2094that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2095modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2096registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2097
2098@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2099programs:
2100
2101@itemize @bullet
2102@item automatic notification of new threads
2103@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2104@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2105@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2106a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2107@item thread-specific breakpoints
2108@end itemize
2109
c906108c
SS
2110@quotation
2111@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2112@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2113If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2114effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2115from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2116like this:
2117
2118@smallexample
2119(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2120(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2121Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2122see the IDs of currently known threads.
2123@end smallexample
2124@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2125@c doesn't support threads"?
2126@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2127
2128@cindex focus of debugging
2129@cindex current thread
2130The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2131threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2132control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2133This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2134program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2135
41afff9a 2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2137@cindex thread identifier (system)
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145LynxOS, you might see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2153the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2154further qualifier.
2155
2156@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2157@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2158@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2159@c program?
2160@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2161@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2162@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2163
2164@cindex thread number
2165@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2166For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2167number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2168
2169@table @code
2170@kindex info threads
2171@item info threads
2172Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2173program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2174
2175@enumerate
2176@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2177
2178@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2179
2180@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2181@end enumerate
2182
2183@noindent
2184An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2185indicates the current thread.
2186
5d161b24 2187For example,
c906108c
SS
2188@end table
2189@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2190
2191@smallexample
2192(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2193 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2194 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2195* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2196 at threadtest.c:68
2197@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2198
2199On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2200
2201@cindex thread number
2202@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2203For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2204number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2205thread in your program.
2206
41afff9a
EZ
2207@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2208@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2209@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2210@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2211@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2212Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2213both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2214form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2215whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2216HP-UX, you see
2217
474c8240 2218@smallexample
c906108c 2219[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2220@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2221
2222@noindent
5d161b24 2223when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info threads
2227@item info threads
2228Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2229program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2230
2231@enumerate
2232@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2233
2234@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2235
2236@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2237@end enumerate
2238
2239@noindent
2240An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2241indicates the current thread.
2242
5d161b24 2243For example,
c906108c
SS
2244@end table
2245@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2246
474c8240 2247@smallexample
c906108c 2248(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2249 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2250 at quicksort.c:137
2251 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2252 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2253 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2254 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2255@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2256
2257@table @code
2258@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2259@item thread @var{threadno}
2260Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2261argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2262shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2263@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2264you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2265
2266@smallexample
2267@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2268(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2269[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
22700x34e5 in sigpause ()
2271@end smallexample
2272
2273@noindent
2274As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2275@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2276threads.
c906108c
SS
2277
2278@kindex thread apply
2279@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2280The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2281more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2282with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2283@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2284threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2285@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2286@end table
2287
2288@cindex automatic thread selection
2289@cindex switching threads automatically
2290@cindex threads, automatic switching
2291Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2292signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2293signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2294message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2295thread.
2296
2297@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2298more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2299programs with multiple threads.
2300
2301@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2302watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2303
6d2ebf8b 2304@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2305@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2306
2307@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2308@cindex multiple processes
2309@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2310On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2311programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2312function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2313parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2314set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2315will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2316will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2317
2318However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2319which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2320the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2321only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2322so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2323on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2324get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2325@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2326the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2327the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2328
b51970ac
DJ
2329On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2330create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2331Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2332only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
c906108c
SS
2333
2334By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2335the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2336
2337If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2338use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2339
2340@table @code
2341@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2342@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2343Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2344@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2345process. The @var{mode} can be:
2346
2347@table @code
2348@item parent
2349The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2350unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2351
2352@item child
2353The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2354unimpeded.
2355
c906108c
SS
2356@end table
2357
2358@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2359Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2360@end table
2361
2362If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2363@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2364breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2365@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2366the child process's @code{main}.
2367
2368When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2369child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2370
2371If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2372call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2373use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2374argument.
2375
2376You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2377a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2378Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2379
6d2ebf8b 2380@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2381@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2382
2383The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2384program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2385trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2386
7a292a7a
SS
2387Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2388such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2389@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2390change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2391continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2392ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2393explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2394
2395@table @code
2396@kindex info program
2397@item info program
2398Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2399running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2400@end table
2401
2402@menu
2403* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2404* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2405* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2406* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2407@end menu
2408
6d2ebf8b 2409@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2410@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2411
2412@cindex breakpoints
2413A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2414the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2415control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2416breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2417Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2418should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2419program.
2420
2421In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2422breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2423a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2424is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2425not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2426arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2427
2428@cindex watchpoints
2429@cindex memory tracing
2430@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2431@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2432A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2433when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2434command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2435watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2436any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2437and watchpoints using the same commands.
2438
2439You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2440whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2441Automatic display}.
2442
2443@cindex catchpoints
2444@cindex breakpoint on events
2445A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2446when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2447exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2448different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2449catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2450other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2451@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2452
2453@cindex breakpoint numbers
2454@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2455@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2456catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2457starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2458features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2459breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2460@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2461enable it again.
2462
c5394b80
JM
2463@cindex breakpoint ranges
2464@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2465Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2466operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2467@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2468hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2469all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2470
c906108c
SS
2471@menu
2472* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2473* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2474* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2475* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2476* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2477* Conditions:: Break conditions
2478* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2479* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2480* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
e4d5f7e1 2481* Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
c906108c
SS
2482@end menu
2483
6d2ebf8b 2484@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2485@subsection Setting breakpoints
2486
5d161b24 2487@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2488@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2489@c
2490@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2491
2492@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2493@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2494@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2495@cindex latest breakpoint
2496Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2497@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2498number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2499Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2500convenience variables.
2501
2502You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2503
2504@table @code
2505@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2506Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2507When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2508C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2509@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2510
2511@item break +@var{offset}
2512@itemx break -@var{offset}
2513Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2514at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2515(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2516
2517@item break @var{linenum}
2518Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2519The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2520The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2521code on that line.
2522
2523@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2524Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2525
2526@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2527Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2528@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2529superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2530functions.
2531
2532@item break *@var{address}
2533Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2534breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2535information or source files.
2536
2537@item break
2538When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2539the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2540(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2541innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2542returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2543@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2544that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2545@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2546the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2547inside loops.
2548
2549@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2550least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2551would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2552breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2553existed when your program stopped.
2554
2555@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2556Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2557@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2558value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2559@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2560above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2561,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2562
2563@kindex tbreak
2564@item tbreak @var{args}
2565Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2566same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2567way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2568program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2569
c906108c
SS
2570@kindex hbreak
2571@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2572Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2573@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2574breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2575have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2576debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2577changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2578provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2579will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2580address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2581breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2582example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2583@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2584or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2585(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
501eef12
AC
2586@xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2587
c906108c
SS
2588
2589@kindex thbreak
2590@item thbreak @var{args}
2591Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2592are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2593the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2594the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2595first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2596command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2597may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2598See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2599
2600@kindex rbreak
2601@cindex regular expression
2602@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2603Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2604@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2605matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2606breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2607the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2608them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2609
2610The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2611like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2612shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2613an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2614@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2615match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2616
b37052ae 2617When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2618breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2619classes.
c906108c
SS
2620
2621@kindex info breakpoints
2622@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2623@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2624@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2625@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2626Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2627not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2628
2629@table @emph
2630@item Breakpoint Numbers
2631@item Type
2632Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2633@item Disposition
2634Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2635@item Enabled or Disabled
2636Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2637that are not enabled.
2638@item Address
2650777c
JJ
2639Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2640breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2641will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
c906108c
SS
2642@item What
2643Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2650777c
JJ
2644line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2645the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2646the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
c906108c
SS
2647@end table
2648
2649@noindent
2650If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2651the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2650777c
JJ
2652are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
2653specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
2654library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
2655valid location.
c906108c
SS
2656
2657@noindent
2658@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2659number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2660convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2661the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2662listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2666has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2667@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2668hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2669was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2670will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2671@end table
2672
2673@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2674your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2675the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2676(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2677
2650777c 2678@cindex pending breakpoints
dd79a6cf
JJ
2679If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
2680that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
2681a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
2682a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
2683attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
2684gets loaded.
2685
2686Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
2650777c
JJ
2687@value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
2688later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
dd79a6cf
JJ
2689a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
2690If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
2691a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
2692
2693@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
2694breakpoint support:
2695
2696@kindex set breakpoint pending
2697@kindex show breakpoint pending
2698@table @code
2699@item set breakpoint pending auto
2700This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
2701location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
2702
2703@item set breakpoint pending on
2704This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
2705result in a pending breakpoint being created.
2706
2707@item set breakpoint pending off
2708This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
2709unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
2710not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
2711
2712@item show breakpoint pending
2713Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
2714@end table
2650777c 2715
649e03f6
RM
2716@cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
2717Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
2718specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
2650777c
JJ
2719breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
2720the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
2721the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
2722pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
2723tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
2724shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
649e03f6 2725@value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
2650777c
JJ
2726This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
2727occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
2728of these loads could resolve the location.
2729
c906108c
SS
2730@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2731@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2732@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2733special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2734programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2735starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2736You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2737@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2738
2739
6d2ebf8b 2740@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2741@subsection Setting watchpoints
2742
2743@cindex setting watchpoints
2744@cindex software watchpoints
2745@cindex hardware watchpoints
2746You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2747expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2748this may happen.
2749
2750Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2751hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2752program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2753times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2754catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2755culprit.)
2756
1104b9e7 2757On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2758@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2759hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2760program.
2761
2762@table @code
2763@kindex watch
2764@item watch @var{expr}
2765Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2766is written into by the program and its value changes.
2767
2768@kindex rwatch
2769@item rwatch @var{expr}
2770Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2771
2772@kindex awatch
2773@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2774Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2775by the program.
c906108c
SS
2776
2777@kindex info watchpoints
2778@item info watchpoints
2779This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2780it is the same as @code{info break}.
2781@end table
2782
2783@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2784watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2785value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2786cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2787executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2788statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2789
2790When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2791
474c8240 2792@smallexample
c906108c 2793Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2794@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2795
2796@noindent
2797if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2798
7be570e7
JM
2799Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2800hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2801value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2802every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2803that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2804hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2805will print a message like this:
2806
2807@smallexample
2808Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2809@end smallexample
2810
2811Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2812data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2813watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2814can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2815cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2816double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2817wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2818into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2819
2820If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2821to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2822Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2823time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2824able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2825warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2826
2827@smallexample
2828Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2829@end smallexample
2830
2831@noindent
2832If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2833
2834The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2835or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2836data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2837hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2838both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2839watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2840@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2841watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2842@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2843Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2844
2845If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2846any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2847kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2848
7be570e7
JM
2849@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2850(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2851they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2852which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2853being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2854and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2855rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2856way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2857@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2858
c906108c
SS
2859@quotation
2860@cindex watchpoints and threads
2861@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2862@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2863usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2864can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2865you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2866thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2867can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2868@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2869the expression.
53a5351d 2870
d4f3574e 2871@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2872@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2873have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2874watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2875single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2876change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2877confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2878software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2879when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2880watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2881@end quotation
c906108c 2882
501eef12
AC
2883@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2884
6d2ebf8b 2885@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2886@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2887@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2888@cindex exception handlers
2889@cindex event handling
2890
2891You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2892kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2893shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2894
2895@table @code
2896@kindex catch
2897@item catch @var{event}
2898Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2899@table @code
2900@item throw
2901@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2902The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2903
2904@item catch
2905@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2906The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2907
2908@item exec
2909@kindex catch exec
2910A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2911
2912@item fork
2913@kindex catch fork
2914A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2915
2916@item vfork
2917@kindex catch vfork
2918A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2919
2920@item load
2921@itemx load @var{libname}
2922@kindex catch load
2923The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2924@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2925
2926@item unload
2927@itemx unload @var{libname}
2928@kindex catch unload
2929The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2930of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2931@end table
2932
2933@item tcatch @var{event}
2934Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2935automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2936
2937@end table
2938
2939Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2940
b37052ae 2941There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2942(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2943
2944@itemize @bullet
2945@item
2946If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2947control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2948raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2949returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2950simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2951that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2952you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2953disabled within interactive calls.
2954
2955@item
2956You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2957
2958@item
2959You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2960@end itemize
2961
2962@cindex raise exceptions
2963Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2964if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2965stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2966can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2967breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2968out where the exception was raised.
2969
2970To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2971knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2972raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2973which has the following ANSI C interface:
2974
474c8240 2975@smallexample
c906108c 2976 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2977 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2978 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2979@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2980
2981@noindent
2982To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2983unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2984(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2985
2986With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2987that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2988a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2989breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2990raised.
2991
2992
6d2ebf8b 2993@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2994@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2995
2996@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2997@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2998It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2999catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3000to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3001breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3002
3003With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3004where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3005delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3006their breakpoint numbers.
3007
3008It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3009automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3010when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3011
3012@table @code
3013@kindex clear
3014@item clear
3015Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3016selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3017the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3018breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3019
3020@item clear @var{function}
3021@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3022Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
3023
3024@item clear @var{linenum}
3025@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3026Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
3027
3028@cindex delete breakpoints
3029@kindex delete
41afff9a 3030@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
3031@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3032Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3033ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
3034breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3035confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3036@end table
3037
6d2ebf8b 3038@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
3039@subsection Disabling breakpoints
3040
3041@kindex disable breakpoints
3042@kindex enable breakpoints
3043Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3044prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3045it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3046that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3047
3048You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3049the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3050or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3051@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3052catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3053
3054A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3055states of enablement:
3056
3057@itemize @bullet
3058@item
3059Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3060with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3061@item
3062Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3063@item
3064Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 3065disabled.
c906108c
SS
3066@item
3067Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
3068immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3069set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
3070@end itemize
3071
3072You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3073watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3074
3075@table @code
3076@kindex disable breakpoints
3077@kindex disable
41afff9a 3078@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 3079@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
3080Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3081listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3082options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3083case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3084@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3085
3086@kindex enable breakpoints
3087@kindex enable
c5394b80 3088@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
3089Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3090become effective once again in stopping your program.
3091
c5394b80 3092@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
3093Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3094of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3095
c5394b80 3096@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
3097Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3098deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3099@end table
3100
d4f3574e
SS
3101@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3102@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
3103Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3104,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3105subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3106the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3107breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3108breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3109stepping}.)
3110
6d2ebf8b 3111@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
3112@subsection Break conditions
3113@cindex conditional breakpoints
3114@cindex breakpoint conditions
3115
3116@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 3117@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
3118The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3119specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3120breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3121programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3122a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3123and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3124
3125This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3126situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3127when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3128by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3129@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3130
3131Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3132since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3133it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3134and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3135one.
3136
3137Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3138your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3139that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3140format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3141unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3142that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3143program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3144breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3145conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3146purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3147(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3148
3149Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3150@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3151Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3152with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3153
c906108c
SS
3154You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3155The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3156@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3157catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3158
3159@table @code
3160@kindex condition
3161@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3162Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3163watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3164breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3165@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3166@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3167syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3168referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3169symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3170prints an error message:
3171
474c8240 3172@smallexample
d4f3574e 3173No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3174@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3175
3176@noindent
c906108c
SS
3177@value{GDBN} does
3178not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3179command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3180@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3181
3182@item condition @var{bnum}
3183Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3184an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3185@end table
3186
3187@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3188A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3189breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3190useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3191count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3192is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3193therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3194ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3195the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3196value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3197your program reaches it.
3198
3199@table @code
3200@kindex ignore
3201@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3202Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3203The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3204execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3205takes no action.
3206
3207To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3208a count of zero.
3209
3210When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3211breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3212@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3213Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3214
3215If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3216condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3217@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3218
3219You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3220as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3221is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3222variables}.
3223@end table
3224
3225Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3226
3227
6d2ebf8b 3228@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3229@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3230
3231@cindex breakpoint commands
3232You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3233commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3234example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3235enable other breakpoints.
3236
3237@table @code
3238@kindex commands
3239@kindex end
3240@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3241@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3242@itemx end
3243Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3244themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3245@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3246
3247To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3248follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3249
3250With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3251breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3252recently encountered).
3253@end table
3254
3255Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3256disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3257
3258You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3259use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3260that resumes execution.
3261
3262Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3263execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3264(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3265another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3266ambiguities about which list to execute.
3267
3268@kindex silent
3269If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3270usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3271be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3272then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3273see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3274meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3275
3276The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3277print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3278breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3279
3280For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3281value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3282
474c8240 3283@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3284break foo if x>0
3285commands
3286silent
3287printf "x is %d\n",x
3288cont
3289end
474c8240 3290@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3291
3292One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3293you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3294of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3295erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3296to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3297so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3298command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3299
474c8240 3300@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3301break 403
3302commands
3303silent
3304set x = y + 4
3305cont
3306end
474c8240 3307@end smallexample
c906108c 3308
6d2ebf8b 3309@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3310@subsection Breakpoint menus
3311@cindex overloading
3312@cindex symbol overloading
3313
b383017d 3314Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
b37303ee 3315single function name
c906108c
SS
3316to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3317This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3318@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3319a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3320something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3321particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3322you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3323waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3324options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3325sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3326@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3327breakpoints.
3328
3329For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3330breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3331We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3332
3333@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3334@smallexample
3335@group
3336(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3337[0] cancel
3338[1] all
3339[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3340[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3341[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3342[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3343[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3344[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3345> 2 4 6
3346Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3347Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3348Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3349Multiple breakpoints were set.
3350Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3351 breakpoints.
3352(@value{GDBP})
3353@end group
3354@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3355
3356@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3357@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3358@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3359@c
3360@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3361@c
d4f3574e
SS
3362Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3363any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3364attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3365@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3366
474c8240 3367@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3368Cannot insert breakpoints.
3369The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3370@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3371
3372When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3373
3374@enumerate
3375@item
3376Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3377
3378@item
5d161b24 3379Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3380name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3381that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3382Then start your program again.
3383
3384@item
3385Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3386linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3387to nonsharable executables.
3388@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3389@c @end ifclear
3390
d4f3574e
SS
3391A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3392hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3393
3394@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3395@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3396@smallexample
3397Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3398You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3399@end smallexample
3400
3401@noindent
3402This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3403only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3404watchpoints it needs to insert.
3405
3406When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3407hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3408
1485d690
KB
3409@node Breakpoint related warnings
3410@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3411@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3412
3413Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3414which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3415@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3416with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3417
3418One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3419a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3420bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3421constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3422bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3423honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3424first in the bundle.
3425
3426It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3427instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3428a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3429another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3430breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3431printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3432is hit.
3433
3434A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3435that's been subject to address adjustment:
3436
3437@smallexample
3438warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3439@end smallexample
3440
3441Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3442internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3443verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3444desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
b383017d 3445other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
1485d690
KB
3446E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3447instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3448cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3449
3450@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3451adjusted breakpoints:
3452
3453@smallexample
3454warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3455to 0x00010410.
3456@end smallexample
3457
3458When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3459action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3460frequently than expected.
d4f3574e 3461
6d2ebf8b 3462@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3463@section Continuing and stepping
3464
3465@cindex stepping
3466@cindex continuing
3467@cindex resuming execution
3468@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3469completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3470one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3471line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3472particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3473your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3474it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3475@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3476
3477@table @code
3478@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3479@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3480@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3481@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3482@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3483@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3484Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3485any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3486@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3487ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3488@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3489
3490The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3491stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3492@code{continue} is ignored.
3493
d4f3574e
SS
3494The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3495debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3496purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3497@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3498@end table
3499
3500To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3501(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3502calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3503different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3504
3505A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3506(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3507beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3508is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3509and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3510interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3511
3512@table @code
3513@kindex step
41afff9a 3514@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3515@item step
3516Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3517line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3518abbreviated @code{s}.
3519
3520@quotation
3521@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3522@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3523@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3524@c distinction here.
3525@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3526within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3527execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3528debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3529is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3530without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3531below.
3532@end quotation
3533
4a92d011
EZ
3534The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3535line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3536@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3537to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3538the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3539called within the line.
c906108c 3540
d4f3574e
SS
3541Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3542number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3543@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3544on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3545was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3546
3547@item step @var{count}
3548Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3549breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3550@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3551
3552@kindex next
41afff9a 3553@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3554@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3555Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3556This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3557the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3558control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3559that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3560is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3561
3562An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3563
3564
3565@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3566@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3567@c
3568@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3569@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3570@c function are executed without stopping.
3571
d4f3574e
SS
3572The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3573source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3574@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3575
b90a5f51
CF
3576@kindex set step-mode
3577@item set step-mode
3578@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3579@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3580@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3581The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3582stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3583information rather than stepping over it.
3584
4a92d011
EZ
3585This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3586machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3587want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3588
3589@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3590Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3591debug information. This is the default.
3592
c906108c
SS
3593@kindex finish
3594@item finish
3595Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3596returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3597
3598Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3599,Returning from a function}).
3600
3601@kindex until
41afff9a 3602@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3603@item until
3604@itemx u
3605Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3606current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3607stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3608command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3609automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3610than the address of the jump.
3611
3612This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3613though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3614exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3615simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3616through the next iteration.
3617
3618@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3619stack frame.
3620
3621@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3622of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3623example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3624(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3625@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3626
474c8240 3627@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3628(@value{GDBP}) f
3629#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3630206 expand_input();
3631(@value{GDBP}) until
3632195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3633@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3634
3635This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3636generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3637start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3638written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3639to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3640expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3641statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3642
3643@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3644instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3645argument.
3646
3647@item until @var{location}
3648@itemx u @var{location}
3649Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3650reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3651the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3652,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3653hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3654location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3655implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3656invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3657line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3658line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3659invocations have returned.
3660
3661@smallexample
366294 int factorial (int value)
366395 @{
366496 if (value > 1) @{
366597 value *= factorial (value - 1);
366698 @}
366799 return (value);
3668100 @}
3669@end smallexample
3670
3671
3672@kindex advance @var{location}
3673@itemx advance @var{location}
3674Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3675required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3676command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3677frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3678not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3679have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3680
c906108c
SS
3681
3682@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3683@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3684@item stepi
96a2c332 3685@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3686@itemx si
3687Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3688
3689It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3690instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3691instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3692Display,, Automatic display}.
3693
3694An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3695
3696@need 750
3697@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3698@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3699@item nexti
96a2c332 3700@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3701@itemx ni
3702Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3703proceed until the function returns.
3704
3705An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3706@end table
3707
6d2ebf8b 3708@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3709@section Signals
3710@cindex signals
3711
3712A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3713operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3714kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3715signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3716@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3717memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3718the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3719requested an alarm).
3720
3721@cindex fatal signals
3722Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3723functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3724errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3725program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3726@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3727fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3728
3729@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3730program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3731signal.
3732
3733@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3734Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3735@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3736(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3737but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3738You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3739
3740@table @code
3741@kindex info signals
3742@item info signals
96a2c332 3743@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3744Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3745handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3746the defined types of signals.
3747
d4f3574e 3748@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3749
3750@kindex handle
3751@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3752Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3753can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3754@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3755@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3756known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3757@end table
3758
3759@c @group
3760The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3761Their full names are:
3762
3763@table @code
3764@item nostop
3765@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3766still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3767
3768@item stop
3769@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3770the @code{print} keyword as well.
3771
3772@item print
3773@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3774
3775@item noprint
3776@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3777implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3778
3779@item pass
5ece1a18 3780@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3781@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3782can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3783and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3784
3785@item nopass
5ece1a18 3786@itemx ignore
c906108c 3787@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3788@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3789@end table
3790@c @end group
3791
d4f3574e
SS
3792When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3793program until you
c906108c
SS
3794continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3795effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3796after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3797command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3798program sees that signal when you continue.
3799
24f93129
EZ
3800The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3801non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3802@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3803erroneous signals.
3804
c906108c
SS
3805You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3806seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3807or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3808due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3809values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3810execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3811a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3812you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3813program a signal}.
c906108c 3814
6d2ebf8b 3815@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3816@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3817
3818When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3819programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3820breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3821
3822@table @code
3823@cindex breakpoints and threads
3824@cindex thread breakpoints
3825@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3826@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3827@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3828@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3829writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3830
3831Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3832to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3833particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3834numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3835column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3836
3837If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3838breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3839program.
3840
3841You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3842well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3843breakpoint condition, like this:
3844
3845@smallexample
2df3850c 3846(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3847@end smallexample
3848
3849@end table
3850
3851@cindex stopped threads
3852@cindex threads, stopped
3853Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3854@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3855allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3856switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3857underfoot.
3858
36d86913
MC
3859@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
3860@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
3861@cindex premature return from system calls
3862There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
3863breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
3864system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
3865consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
3866that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
3867stop execution.
3868
3869To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
3870each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
3871style anyways.
3872
3873For example, do not write code like this:
3874
3875@smallexample
3876 sleep (10);
3877@end smallexample
3878
3879The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
3880at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
3881
3882Instead, write this:
3883
3884@smallexample
3885 int unslept = 10;
3886 while (unslept > 0)
3887 unslept = sleep (unslept);
3888@end smallexample
3889
3890A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
3891conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
3892multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
3893@value{GDBN}.
3894
3895Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
3896monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
3897When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
3898prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
3899
c906108c
SS
3900@cindex continuing threads
3901@cindex threads, continuing
3902Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3903executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3904like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3905
3906In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3907Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3908system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3909execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3910single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3911statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3912stops.
3913
3914You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3915continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3916thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3917first thread completes whatever you requested.
3918
3919On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3920thread to run.
3921
3922@table @code
3923@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3924Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3925locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3926current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3927mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3928``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3929stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3930when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3931function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3932like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3933thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3934@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3935
3936@item show scheduler-locking
3937Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3938@end table
3939
c906108c 3940
6d2ebf8b 3941@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3942@chapter Examining the Stack
3943
3944When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3945stopped and how it got there.
3946
3947@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3948Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3949is generated.
3950That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3951the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3952and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3953The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3954The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3955stack}.
3956
3957When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3958stack allow you to see all of this information.
3959
3960@cindex selected frame
3961One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3962@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3963particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3964your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3965special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3966interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3967
3968When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3969currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3970@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3971
3972@menu
3973* Frames:: Stack frames
3974* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3975* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3976* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3977
3978@end menu
3979
6d2ebf8b 3980@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3981@section Stack frames
3982
d4f3574e 3983@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3984@cindex stack frame
3985The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3986frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3987with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3988to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3989which the function is executing.
3990
3991@cindex initial frame
3992@cindex outermost frame
3993@cindex innermost frame
3994When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3995function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3996@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3997made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3998is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3999the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4000actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4001recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4002
4003@cindex frame pointer
4004Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4005stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4006kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4007address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4008in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
4009going on in that frame.
4010
4011@cindex frame number
4012@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4013zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4014and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4015they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4016frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4017
6d2ebf8b
SS
4018@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4019@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
4020@cindex frameless execution
4021Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 4022without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 4023@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 4024@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 4025@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 4026generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
4027This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4028the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4029with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4030has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4031it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4032correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4033no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4034
4035@table @code
d4f3574e 4036@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 4037@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 4038@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 4039The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 4040and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
4041address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4042@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
4043
4044@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 4045@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
4046@item select-frame
4047The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4048to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4049@code{frame}.
4050@end table
4051
6d2ebf8b 4052@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
4053@section Backtraces
4054
4055@cindex backtraces
4056@cindex tracebacks
4057@cindex stack traces
4058A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4059line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4060frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4061stack.
4062
4063@table @code
4064@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 4065@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
4066@item backtrace
4067@itemx bt
4068Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4069frames in the stack.
4070
4071You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4072character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4073
4074@item backtrace @var{n}
4075@itemx bt @var{n}
4076Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4077
4078@item backtrace -@var{n}
4079@itemx bt -@var{n}
4080Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4081@end table
4082
4083@kindex where
4084@kindex info stack
41afff9a 4085@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
4086The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4087are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4088
4089Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4090The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4091print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4092line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4093counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4094line number.
4095
4096Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4097@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4098
4099@smallexample
4100@group
5d161b24 4101#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
4102 at builtin.c:993
4103#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4104#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4105 at macro.c:71
4106(More stack frames follow...)
4107@end group
4108@end smallexample
4109
4110@noindent
4111The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4112value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4113code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4114
25d29d70
AC
4115@kindex set backtrace past-main
4116@kindex show backtrace past-main
4117@kindex set backtrace limit
4118@kindex show backtrace limit
b4e9345d 4119
25d29d70
AC
4120Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4121libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4122@code{main}. When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4123it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4124system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4125
4126If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4127in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
95f90d25
DJ
4128
4129@table @code
25d29d70
AC
4130@item set backtrace past-main
4131@itemx set backtrace past-main on
4132Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4133
4134@item set backtrace past-main off
95f90d25
DJ
4135Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4136default.
4137
25d29d70
AC
4138@item show backtrace past-main
4139Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4140
4141@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4142@itemx set backtrace limit 0
4143@cindex backtrace limit
4144Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4145unlimited.
95f90d25 4146
25d29d70
AC
4147@item show backtrace limit
4148Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
95f90d25
DJ
4149@end table
4150
6d2ebf8b 4151@node Selection
c906108c
SS
4152@section Selecting a frame
4153
4154Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4155whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4156selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4157of the stack frame just selected.
4158
4159@table @code
d4f3574e 4160@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 4161@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
4162@item frame @var{n}
4163@itemx f @var{n}
4164Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4165(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4166innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4167@code{main}.
4168
4169@item frame @var{addr}
4170@itemx f @var{addr}
4171Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4172chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4173impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4174addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4175switches between them.
4176
c906108c
SS
4177On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4178select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4179
4180On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4181pointer and a program counter.
4182
4183On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4184pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4185@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
4186@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
4187@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
4188
4189@kindex up
4190@item up @var{n}
4191Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4192advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4193that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4194
4195@kindex down
41afff9a 4196@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
4197@item down @var{n}
4198Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4199advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4200that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4201abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4202@end table
4203
4204All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4205frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4206arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 4207frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
4208
4209@need 1000
4210For example:
4211
4212@smallexample
4213@group
4214(@value{GDBP}) up
4215#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4216 at env.c:10
421710 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4218@end group
4219@end smallexample
4220
4221After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4222prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
4223You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4224editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4225@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4226for details.
c906108c
SS
4227
4228@table @code
4229@kindex down-silently
4230@kindex up-silently
4231@item up-silently @var{n}
4232@itemx down-silently @var{n}
4233These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4234respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4235causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4236in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4237distracting.
4238@end table
4239
6d2ebf8b 4240@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4241@section Information about a frame
4242
4243There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4244stack frame.
4245
4246@table @code
4247@item frame
4248@itemx f
4249When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4250frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4251selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4252argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4253@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4254
4255@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4256@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4257@item info frame
4258@itemx info f
4259This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4260including:
4261
4262@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4263@item
4264the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4265@item
4266the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4267@item
4268the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4269@item
4270the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4271@item
4272the address of the frame's arguments
4273@item
d4f3574e
SS
4274the address of the frame's local variables
4275@item
c906108c
SS
4276the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4277@item
4278which registers were saved in the frame
4279@end itemize
4280
4281@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4282something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4283the usual conventions.
4284
4285@item info frame @var{addr}
4286@itemx info f @var{addr}
4287Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4288selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4289command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4290architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4291@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4292
4293@kindex info args
4294@item info args
4295Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4296
4297@item info locals
4298@kindex info locals
4299Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4300line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4301accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4302
c906108c 4303@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4304@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4305@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4306@item info catch
4307Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4308current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4309exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4310@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4311@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4312
c906108c
SS
4313@end table
4314
c906108c 4315
6d2ebf8b 4316@node Source
c906108c
SS
4317@chapter Examining Source Files
4318
4319@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4320information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4321used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4322the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4323(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4324execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4325source files by explicit command.
4326
7a292a7a 4327If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4328prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4329@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4330
4331@menu
4332* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4333* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4334* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4335* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4336* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4337@end menu
4338
6d2ebf8b 4339@node List
c906108c
SS
4340@section Printing source lines
4341
4342@kindex list
41afff9a 4343@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4344To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4345(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4346There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4347
4348Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4349
4350@table @code
4351@item list @var{linenum}
4352Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4353current source file.
4354
4355@item list @var{function}
4356Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4357@var{function}.
4358
4359@item list
4360Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4361@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4362printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4363as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4364Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4365
4366@item list -
4367Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4368@end table
4369
4370By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4371the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4372
4373@table @code
4374@kindex set listsize
4375@item set listsize @var{count}
4376Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4377the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4378
4379@kindex show listsize
4380@item show listsize
4381Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4382@end table
4383
4384Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4385so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4386than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4387argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4388each repetition moves up in the source file.
4389
4390@cindex linespec
4391In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4392@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4393of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4394Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4395
4396@table @code
4397@item list @var{linespec}
4398Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4399
4400@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4401Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4402linespecs.
4403
4404@item list ,@var{last}
4405Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4406
4407@item list @var{first},
4408Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4409
4410@item list +
4411Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4412
4413@item list -
4414Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4415
4416@item list
4417As described in the preceding table.
4418@end table
4419
4420Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4421kinds of linespec.
4422
4423@table @code
4424@item @var{number}
4425Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4426When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4427the same source file as the first linespec.
4428
4429@item +@var{offset}
4430Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4431When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4432two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4433first linespec.
4434
4435@item -@var{offset}
4436Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4437
4438@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4439Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4440
4441@item @var{function}
4442Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4443For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4444
4445@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4446Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4447function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4448file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4449identically named functions in different source files.
4450
4451@item *@var{address}
4452Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4453@var{address} may be any expression.
4454@end table
4455
87885426
FN
4456@node Edit
4457@section Editing source files
4458@cindex editing source files
4459
4460@kindex edit
4461@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4462To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4463The editing program of your choice
4464is invoked with the current line set to
4465the active line in the program.
4466Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4467want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4468
4469Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4470
4471@table @code
4472@item edit
4473Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4474
4475@item edit @var{number}
4476Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4477
4478@item edit @var{function}
4479Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4480
4481@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4482Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4483
4484@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4485Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4486function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4487file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4488identically named functions in different source files.
4489
4490@item edit *@var{address}
4491Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4492@var{address} may be any expression.
4493@end table
4494
4495@subsection Choosing your editor
4496You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4497@footnote{
4498The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4499following command-line syntax:
10998722 4500@smallexample
87885426 4501ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4502@end smallexample
4503The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4504the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4505by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4506@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4507@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4508@smallexample
87885426
FN
4509EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4510export EDITOR
4511gdb ...
10998722 4512@end smallexample
87885426 4513or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4514@smallexample
87885426
FN
4515setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4516gdb ...
10998722 4517@end smallexample
87885426 4518
6d2ebf8b 4519@node Search
c906108c
SS
4520@section Searching source files
4521@cindex searching
4522@kindex reverse-search
4523
4524There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4525regular expression.
4526
4527@table @code
4528@kindex search
4529@kindex forward-search
4530@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4531@itemx search @var{regexp}
4532The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4533starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4534@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4535synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4536@code{fo}.
4537
4538@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4539The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4540with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4541for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4542this command as @code{rev}.
4543@end table
c906108c 4544
6d2ebf8b 4545@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4546@section Specifying source directories
4547
4548@cindex source path
4549@cindex directories for source files
4550Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4551files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4552the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4553session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4554this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4555it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4556in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4557the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4558the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4559path.
4560
4561If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4562object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4563too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4564compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4565last resort.
4566
4567Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4568any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4569each line is in the file.
4570
4571@kindex directory
4572@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4573When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4574and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4575To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4576
4577@table @code
4578@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4579@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4580Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4581directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4582(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4583part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4584whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4585path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4586
4587@kindex cdir
4588@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4589@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4590@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4591@cindex compilation directory
4592@cindex current directory
4593@cindex working directory
4594@cindex directory, current
4595@cindex directory, compilation
4596You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4597directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4598working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4599tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4600session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4601directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4602
4603@item directory
4604Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4605
4606@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4607@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4608
4609@item show directories
4610@kindex show directories
4611Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4612@end table
4613
4614If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4615interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4616versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4617
4618@enumerate
4619@item
4620Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4621
4622@item
4623Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4624directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4625directories in one command.
4626@end enumerate
4627
6d2ebf8b 4628@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4629@section Source and machine code
4630
4631You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4632addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4633a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4634mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4635line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4636well as hex.
4637
4638@table @code
4639@kindex info line
4640@item info line @var{linespec}
4641Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4642source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4643the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4644source lines}).
4645@end table
4646
4647For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4648the object code for the first line of function
4649@code{m4_changequote}:
4650
d4f3574e
SS
4651@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4652@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4653@smallexample
96a2c332 4654(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4655Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4656@end smallexample
4657
4658@noindent
4659We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4660@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4661@smallexample
4662(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4663Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4664@end smallexample
4665
4666@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4667@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4668After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4669is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4670sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4671,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4672convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4673variables}).
4674
4675@table @code
4676@kindex disassemble
4677@cindex assembly instructions
4678@cindex instructions, assembly
4679@cindex machine instructions
4680@cindex listing machine instructions
4681@item disassemble
4682This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4683instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4684program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4685command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4686surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4687(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4688@end table
4689
c906108c
SS
4690The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4691HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4692
4693@smallexample
4694(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4695Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
46960x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
46970x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
46980x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
46990x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
47000x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
47010x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
47020x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
47030x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4704End of assembler dump.
4705@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4706
4707Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4708mnemonics or other syntax.
4709
4710@table @code
d4f3574e 4711@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4712@cindex assembly instructions
4713@cindex instructions, assembly
4714@cindex machine instructions
4715@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4716@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4717@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4718@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4719Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4720program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4721
4722Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4723can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4724The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4725assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4726@end table
4727
4728
6d2ebf8b 4729@node Data
c906108c
SS
4730@chapter Examining Data
4731
4732@cindex printing data
4733@cindex examining data
4734@kindex print
4735@kindex inspect
4736@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4737@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4738@c different window or something like that.
4739The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4740command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4741evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4742program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4743Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4744
4745@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4746@item print @var{expr}
4747@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4748@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4749value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4750you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4751@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4752formats}.
4753
4754@item print
4755@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4756If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4757@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4758conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4759@end table
4760
4761A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4762It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4763specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4764
7a292a7a 4765If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4766fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4767command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4768Table}.
c906108c
SS
4769
4770@menu
4771* Expressions:: Expressions
4772* Variables:: Program variables
4773* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4774* Output Formats:: Output formats
4775* Memory:: Examining memory
4776* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4777* Print Settings:: Print settings
4778* Value History:: Value history
4779* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4780* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4781* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4782* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
b383017d 4783* Auxiliary Vector:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
29e57380 4784* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4785* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4786* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4787 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4788@end menu
4789
6d2ebf8b 4790@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4791@section Expressions
4792
4793@cindex expressions
4794@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4795compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4796by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4797@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4798casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4799you compiled your program to include this information; see
4800@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4801
d4f3574e
SS
4802@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4803the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4804you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4805memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4806
c906108c
SS
4807Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4808this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4809Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4810languages.
4811
4812In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4813expressions regardless of your programming language.
4814
4815Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4816useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4817at that address in memory.
4818@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4819
4820@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4821to programming languages:
4822
4823@table @code
4824@item @@
4825@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4826@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4827
4828@item ::
4829@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4830function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4831
4832@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4833@cindex type casting memory
4834@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4835@cindex casts, to view memory
4836@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4837Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4838memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4839pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4840a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4841normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4842@end table
4843
6d2ebf8b 4844@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4845@section Program variables
4846
4847The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4848in your program.
4849
4850Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4851(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4852
4853@itemize @bullet
4854@item
4855global (or file-static)
4856@end itemize
4857
5d161b24 4858@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4859
4860@itemize @bullet
4861@item
4862visible according to the scope rules of the
4863programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4864@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4865
4866@noindent This means that in the function
4867
474c8240 4868@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4869foo (a)
4870 int a;
4871@{
4872 bar (a);
4873 @{
4874 int b = test ();
4875 bar (b);
4876 @}
4877@}
474c8240 4878@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4879
4880@noindent
4881you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4882executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4883examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4884the block where @code{b} is declared.
4885
4886@cindex variable name conflict
4887There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4888scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4889in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4890function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4891happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4892you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4893using the colon-colon notation:
4894
d4f3574e 4895@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4896@iftex
4897@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4898@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4899@end iftex
474c8240 4900@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4901@var{file}::@var{variable}
4902@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4903@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4904
4905@noindent
4906Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4907static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4908make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4909to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4910
474c8240 4911@smallexample
c906108c 4912(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4913@end smallexample
c906108c 4914
b37052ae 4915@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4916This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4917use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4918scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4919@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4920@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4921
4922@cindex wrong values
4923@cindex variable values, wrong
4924@quotation
4925@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4926wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4927scope, and just before exit.
4928@end quotation
4929You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4930This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4931set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4932stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4933values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4934also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4935after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4936variable definitions may be gone.
4937
4938This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4939To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4940when compiling.
4941
d4f3574e
SS
4942@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4943Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4944unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4945opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4946offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4947might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4948happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4949
474c8240 4950@smallexample
d4f3574e 4951No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4952@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4953
4954To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4955different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
0179ffac
DC
4956formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4957usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4958produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4959COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4960an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4961for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
d4f3574e
SS
4962
4963
6d2ebf8b 4964@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4965@section Artificial arrays
4966
4967@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4968@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4969It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4970same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4971dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4972program.
4973
4974You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4975@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4976operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4977and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4978of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4979the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4980argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4981following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4982example. If a program says
4983
474c8240 4984@smallexample
c906108c 4985int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4986@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4987
4988@noindent
4989you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4990
474c8240 4991@smallexample
c906108c 4992p *array@@len
474c8240 4993@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4994
4995The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4996with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4997subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4998Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4999(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5000
5001Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5002This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5003The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 5004@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5005(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5006$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 5007@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5008
5009As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 5010@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 5011the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 5012@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5013(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5014$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 5015@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5016
5017Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5018moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5019actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5020of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5021to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5022variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5023interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5024instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5025structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5026in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5027
474c8240 5028@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5029set $i = 0
5030p dtab[$i++]->fv
5031@key{RET}
5032@key{RET}
5033@dots{}
474c8240 5034@end smallexample
c906108c 5035
6d2ebf8b 5036@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
5037@section Output formats
5038
5039@cindex formatted output
5040@cindex output formats
5041By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5042this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5043in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5044at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5045these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5046
5047The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5048already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5049@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5050letters supported are:
5051
5052@table @code
5053@item x
5054Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5055hexadecimal.
5056
5057@item d
5058Print as integer in signed decimal.
5059
5060@item u
5061Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5062
5063@item o
5064Print as integer in octal.
5065
5066@item t
5067Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5068@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5069used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 5070see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
5071
5072@item a
5073@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 5074@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
5075Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5076the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5077where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5078
474c8240 5079@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5080(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5081$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 5082@end smallexample
c906108c 5083
3d67e040
EZ
5084@noindent
5085The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5086@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5087
c906108c
SS
5088@item c
5089Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
5090
5091@item f
5092Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5093using typical floating point syntax.
5094@end table
5095
5096For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5097
474c8240 5098@smallexample
c906108c 5099p/x $pc
474c8240 5100@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5101
5102@noindent
5103Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5104names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5105
5106To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5107you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5108expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5109
6d2ebf8b 5110@node Memory
c906108c
SS
5111@section Examining memory
5112
5113You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5114any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5115
5116@cindex examining memory
5117@table @code
41afff9a 5118@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
5119@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5120@itemx x @var{addr}
5121@itemx x
5122Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5123@end table
5124
5125@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5126much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5127expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5128If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5129Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5130
5131@table @r
5132@item @var{n}, the repeat count
5133The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5134how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5135@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5136@c 4.1.2.
5137
5138@item @var{f}, the display format
5139The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
5140@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
5141The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
5142The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5143
5144@item @var{u}, the unit size
5145The unit size is any of
5146
5147@table @code
5148@item b
5149Bytes.
5150@item h
5151Halfwords (two bytes).
5152@item w
5153Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5154@item g
5155Giant words (eight bytes).
5156@end table
5157
5158Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5159default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5160@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5161
5162@item @var{addr}, starting display address
5163@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5164memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5165it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5166@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5167@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5168other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5169the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5170starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5171a value from memory).
5172@end table
5173
5174For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5175(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5176starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5177words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 5178@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
5179
5180Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5181letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5182unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5183specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5184(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5185
5186Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5187and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5188@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5189including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 5190alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
5191Code,,Source and machine code}.
5192
5193All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5194easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5195you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5196instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5197with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5198the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5199for successive uses of @code{x}.
5200
5201@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5202The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5203in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5204would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5205subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5206@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5207examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5208@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5209the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5210
5211If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5212are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5213address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5214
6d2ebf8b 5215@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
5216@section Automatic display
5217@cindex automatic display
5218@cindex display of expressions
5219
5220If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5221(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5222display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5223Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5224to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5225The automatic display looks like this:
5226
474c8240 5227@smallexample
c906108c
SS
52282: foo = 38
52293: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 5230@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5231
5232@noindent
5233This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5234displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5235specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5236whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5237format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5238or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5239supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5240
5241@table @code
5242@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5243@item display @var{expr}
5244Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5245each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5246
5247@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5248
d4f3574e 5249@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5250For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5251count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5252arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5253@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5254
5255@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5256For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5257number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5258be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5259doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5260@end table
5261
5262For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5263instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5264is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5265
5266@table @code
5267@kindex delete display
5268@kindex undisplay
5269@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5270@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5271Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5272
5273@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5274(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5275
5276@kindex disable display
5277@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5278Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5279item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5280enabled again later.
5281
5282@kindex enable display
5283@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5284Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5285again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5286
5287@item display
5288Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5289done when your program stops.
5290
5291@kindex info display
5292@item info display
5293Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5294automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5295values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5296It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5297because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5298@end table
5299
5300If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5301sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5302expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5303variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5304@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5305@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5306continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5307there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5308automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5309is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5310
6d2ebf8b 5311@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5312@section Print settings
5313
5314@cindex format options
5315@cindex print settings
5316@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5317and symbols are printed.
5318
5319@noindent
5320These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5321
5322@table @code
5323@kindex set print address
5324@item set print address
5325@itemx set print address on
5326@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5327traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5328even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5329is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5330@code{set print address on}:
5331
5332@smallexample
5333@group
5334(@value{GDBP}) f
5335#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5336 at input.c:530
5337530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5338@end group
5339@end smallexample
5340
5341@item set print address off
5342Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5343this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5344
5345@smallexample
5346@group
5347(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5348(@value{GDBP}) f
5349#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5350530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5351@end group
5352@end smallexample
5353
5354You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5355dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5356@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5357all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5358
5359@kindex show print address
5360@item show print address
5361Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5362@end table
5363
5364When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5365closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5366identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5367source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5368@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5369you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5370it prints a symbolic address:
5371
5372@table @code
5373@kindex set print symbol-filename
5374@item set print symbol-filename on
5375Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5376symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5377
5378@item set print symbol-filename off
5379Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5380default.
5381
5382@kindex show print symbol-filename
5383@item show print symbol-filename
5384Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5385line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5386@end table
5387
5388Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5389numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5390number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5391
5392Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5393printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5394
5395@table @code
5396@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5397@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5398Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5399offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5400@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5401to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5402
5403@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5404@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5405Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5406symbolic address.
5407@end table
5408
5409@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5410@cindex pointer, finding referent
5411If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5412@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5413and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5414@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5415For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5416at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5417
474c8240 5418@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5419(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5420(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5421$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5422@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5423
5424@quotation
5425@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5426does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5427the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5428@end quotation
5429
5430Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5431
5432@table @code
5433@kindex set print array
5434@item set print array
5435@itemx set print array on
5436Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5437but uses more space. The default is off.
5438
5439@item set print array off
5440Return to compressed format for arrays.
5441
5442@kindex show print array
5443@item show print array
5444Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5445arrays.
5446
5447@kindex set print elements
5448@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5449Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5450If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5451printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5452This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5453When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5454Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5455
5456@kindex show print elements
5457@item show print elements
5458Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5459If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5460
5461@kindex set print null-stop
5462@item set print null-stop
5463Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5464@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5465contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5466The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5467
5468@kindex set print pretty
5469@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5470Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5471per line, like this:
5472
5473@smallexample
5474@group
5475$1 = @{
5476 next = 0x0,
5477 flags = @{
5478 sweet = 1,
5479 sour = 1
5480 @},
5481 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5482@}
5483@end group
5484@end smallexample
5485
5486@item set print pretty off
5487Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5488
5489@smallexample
5490@group
5491$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5492meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5493@end group
5494@end smallexample
5495
5496@noindent
5497This is the default format.
5498
5499@kindex show print pretty
5500@item show print pretty
5501Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5502
5503@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5504@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5505Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5506@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5507character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5508best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5509high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5510
5511@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5512Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5513international character sets, and is the default.
5514
5515@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5516@item show print sevenbit-strings
5517Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5518
5519@kindex set print union
5520@item set print union on
5d161b24 5521Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5522is the default setting.
5523
5524@item set print union off
5525Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5526
5527@kindex show print union
5528@item show print union
5529Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5530structures.
5531
5532For example, given the declarations
5533
5534@smallexample
5535typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5536typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5537typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5538 Bug_forms;
5539
5540struct thing @{
5541 Species it;
5542 union @{
5543 Tree_forms tree;
5544 Bug_forms bug;
5545 @} form;
5546@};
5547
5548struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5549@end smallexample
5550
5551@noindent
5552with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5553
5554@smallexample
5555$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5556@end smallexample
5557
5558@noindent
5559and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5560
5561@smallexample
5562$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5563@end smallexample
5564@end table
5565
c906108c
SS
5566@need 1000
5567@noindent
b37052ae 5568These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5569
5570@table @code
5571@cindex demangling
5572@kindex set print demangle
5573@item set print demangle
5574@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5575Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5576(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5577linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5578
5579@kindex show print demangle
5580@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5581Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5582
5583@kindex set print asm-demangle
5584@item set print asm-demangle
5585@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5586Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5587in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5588The default is off.
5589
5590@kindex show print asm-demangle
5591@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5592Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5593or demangled form.
5594
5595@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5596@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5597@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5598@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5599Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5600represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5601
5602@table @code
5603@item auto
5604Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5605
5606@item gnu
b37052ae 5607Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5608This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5609
5610@item hp
b37052ae 5611Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5612
5613@item lucid
b37052ae 5614Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5615
5616@item arm
b37052ae 5617Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5618@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5619debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5620require further enhancement to permit that.
5621
5622@end table
5623If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5624
5625@kindex show demangle-style
5626@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5627Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5628
5629@kindex set print object
5630@item set print object
5631@itemx set print object on
5632When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5633(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5634the virtual function table.
5635
5636@item set print object off
5637Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5638virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5639
5640@kindex show print object
5641@item show print object
5642Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5643
5644@kindex set print static-members
5645@item set print static-members
5646@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5647Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5648
5649@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5650Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5651
5652@kindex show print static-members
5653@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5654Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5655
5656@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5657@kindex set print vtbl
5658@item set print vtbl
5659@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5660Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5661(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5662ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5663
5664@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5665Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5666
5667@kindex show print vtbl
5668@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5669Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5670@end table
c906108c 5671
6d2ebf8b 5672@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5673@section Value history
5674
5675@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5676Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5677@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5678Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5679(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5680When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5681since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5682symbol table.
5683
5684@cindex @code{$}
5685@cindex @code{$$}
5686@cindex history number
5687The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5688refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5689@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5690printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5691history number.
5692
5693To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5694history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5695remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5696the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5697@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5698is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5699@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5700
5701For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5702want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5703
474c8240 5704@smallexample
c906108c 5705p *$
474c8240 5706@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5707
5708If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5709to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5710
474c8240 5711@smallexample
c906108c 5712p *$.next
474c8240 5713@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5714
5715@noindent
5716You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5717command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5718
5719Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5720@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5721
474c8240 5722@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5723print x
5724set x=5
474c8240 5725@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5726
5727@noindent
5728then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5729remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5730
5731@table @code
5732@kindex show values
5733@item show values
5734Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5735This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5736values} does not change the history.
5737
5738@item show values @var{n}
5739Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5740
5741@item show values +
5742Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5743values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5744@end table
5745
5746Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5747same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5748
6d2ebf8b 5749@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5750@section Convenience variables
5751
5752@cindex convenience variables
5753@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5754@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5755exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5756setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5757of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5758
5759Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5760@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5761the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5762(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5763by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5764
5765You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5766expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5767For example:
5768
474c8240 5769@smallexample
c906108c 5770set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5771@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5772
5773@noindent
5774would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5775@code{object_ptr}.
5776
5777Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5778value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5779value with another assignment at any time.
5780
5781Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5782variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5783that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5784variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5785
5786@table @code
5787@kindex show convenience
5788@item show convenience
5789Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5790Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5791@end table
5792
5793One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5794incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5795a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5796
474c8240 5797@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5798set $i = 0
5799print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5800@end smallexample
c906108c 5801
d4f3574e
SS
5802@noindent
5803Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5804
5805Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5806values likely to be useful.
5807
5808@table @code
41afff9a 5809@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5810@item $_
5811The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5812the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5813commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5814set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5815and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5816except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5817to the type of @code{$__}.
5818
41afff9a 5819@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5820@item $__
5821The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5822to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5823to match the format in which the data was printed.
5824
5825@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5826@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5827The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5828the program being debugged terminates.
5829@end table
5830
53a5351d
JM
5831On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5832begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5833name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5834
6d2ebf8b 5835@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5836@section Registers
5837
5838@cindex registers
5839You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5840with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5841for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5842your machine.
5843
5844@table @code
5845@kindex info registers
5846@item info registers
5847Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5848and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5849
5850@kindex info all-registers
5851@cindex floating point registers
5852@item info all-registers
5853Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5854and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5855
5856@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5857Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5858As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5859the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5860the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5861@end table
5862
5863@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5864expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5865architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5866@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5867the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5868pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5869register that contains the processor status. For example,
5870you could print the program counter in hex with
5871
474c8240 5872@smallexample
c906108c 5873p/x $pc
474c8240 5874@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5875
5876@noindent
5877or print the instruction to be executed next with
5878
474c8240 5879@smallexample
c906108c 5880x/i $pc
474c8240 5881@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5882
5883@noindent
5884or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5885one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5886memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5887stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5888stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5889regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5890see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5891
474c8240 5892@smallexample
c906108c 5893set $sp += 4
474c8240 5894@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5895
5896Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5897your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5898so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5899shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5900registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5901can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5902is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5903
5904@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5905integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5906special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5907registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5908to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5909(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5910@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5911
5912Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5913means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5914the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5915sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5916coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5917programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5918cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5919that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5920prints the data in both formats.
5921
5922Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5923(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5924value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5925were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5926true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5927frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5928
5929However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5930code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5931@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5932frame makes no difference.
5933
6d2ebf8b 5934@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5935@section Floating point hardware
5936@cindex floating point
5937
5938Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5939you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5940
5941@table @code
5942@kindex info float
5943@item info float
5944Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5945point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5946floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5947the ARM and x86 machines.
5948@end table
c906108c 5949
e76f1f2e
AC
5950@node Vector Unit
5951@section Vector Unit
5952@cindex vector unit
5953
5954Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5955more information about the status of the vector unit.
5956
5957@table @code
5958@kindex info vector
5959@item info vector
5960Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5961layout vary depending on the hardware.
5962@end table
5963
b383017d
RM
5964@node Auxiliary Vector
5965@section Operating system auxiliary vector
5966@cindex auxiliary vector
5967@cindex vector, auxiliary
5968
5969Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
5970startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
5971specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
5972binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
5973hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
5974identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
5975Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
5976@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information.
5977
5978@table @code
5979@kindex info auxv
5980@item info auxv
5981Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
e4937fc1 5982live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
b383017d
RM
5983numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
5984tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
e4937fc1 5985pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
b383017d
RM
5986most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
5987an unrecognized tag.
5988@end table
5989
29e57380 5990@node Memory Region Attributes
b383017d 5991@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5992@cindex memory region attributes
5993
b383017d
RM
5994@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5995required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
29e57380
C
5996to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5997use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5998
5999Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6000memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6001accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6002been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6003all memory.
6004
b383017d 6005When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
29e57380
C
6006to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6007
6008@table @code
6009@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
6010@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6011Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6012attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
6013special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6014(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
6015
6016@kindex delete mem
6017@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 6018Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
6019
6020@kindex disable mem
6021@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 6022Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
b383017d 6023A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
29e57380
C
6024It may be enabled again later.
6025
6026@kindex enable mem
6027@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 6028Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
6029
6030@kindex info mem
6031@item info mem
6032Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6033for each region.
6034
6035@table @emph
6036@item Memory Region Number
6037@item Enabled or Disabled.
b383017d 6038Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
29e57380
C
6039Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6040
6041@item Lo Address
6042The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6043
6044@item Hi Address
6045The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6046
6047@item Attributes
6048The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6049@end table
6050@end table
6051
6052
6053@subsection Attributes
6054
b383017d 6055@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
29e57380
C
6056The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6057write accesses to a memory region.
6058
6059While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6060memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6061etc. from accessing memory.
6062
6063@table @code
6064@item ro
6065Memory is read only.
6066@item wo
6067Memory is write only.
6068@item rw
6ca652b0 6069Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
6070@end table
6071
6072@subsubsection Memory Access Size
6073The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6074accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6075require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6076specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6077
6078@table @code
6079@item 8
6080Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6081@item 16
6082Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6083@item 32
6084Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6085@item 64
6086Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6087@end table
6088
6089@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6090@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6091@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6092@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6093@c
6094@c @table @code
6095@c @item hwbreak
b383017d 6096@c Always use hardware breakpoints
29e57380
C
6097@c @item swbreak (default)
6098@c @end table
6099
6100@subsubsection Data Cache
6101The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6102memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6103protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6104does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6105registers.
6106
6107@table @code
6108@item cache
b383017d 6109Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
6110@item nocache
6111Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
6112@end table
6113
6114@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
b383017d 6115@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
29e57380
C
6116@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6117@c
6118@c @table @code
6119@c @item verify
6120@c @item noverify (default)
6121@c @end table
6122
16d9dec6
MS
6123@node Dump/Restore Files
6124@section Copy between memory and a file
6125@cindex dump/restore files
6126@cindex append data to a file
6127@cindex dump data to a file
6128@cindex restore data from a file
16d9dec6 6129
df5215a6
JB
6130You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6131@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6132@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6133@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6134memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6135Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6136files.
6137
6138@table @code
6139
6140@kindex dump
6141@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6142@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6143Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6144or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
16d9dec6 6145
df5215a6 6146The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
16d9dec6 6147@table @code
df5215a6
JB
6148@item binary
6149Raw binary form.
6150@item ihex
6151Intel hex format.
6152@item srec
6153Motorola S-record format.
6154@item tekhex
6155Tektronix Hex format.
6156@end table
6157
6158@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6159@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6160@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6161form.
6162
6163@kindex append
6164@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6165@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6166Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6167or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6168(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6169
6170@kindex restore
6171@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6172Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6173@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6174file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6175must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
16d9dec6 6176
b383017d 6177If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
16d9dec6
MS
6178contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6179they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6180a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6181from that location.
6182
6183If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6184file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
b383017d 6185These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
16d9dec6
MS
6186the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6187
6188@end table
6189
a0eb71c5
KB
6190@node Character Sets
6191@section Character Sets
6192@cindex character sets
6193@cindex charset
6194@cindex translating between character sets
6195@cindex host character set
6196@cindex target character set
6197
6198If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6199represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6200@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6201you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6202character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6203@dfn{target character set}.
6204
6205For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6206uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6207remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6208running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6209then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6210@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
e33d66ec 6211target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
a0eb71c5
KB
6212@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6213character and string literals in expressions.
6214
6215@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6216the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6217target-charset} command, described below.
6218
6219Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6220support:
6221
6222@table @code
6223@item set target-charset @var{charset}
6224@kindex set target-charset
6225Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
e33d66ec
EZ
6226character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6227@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6228list the target character sets it supports.
a0eb71c5
KB
6229@end table
6230
6231@table @code
6232@item set host-charset @var{charset}
6233@kindex set host-charset
6234Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6235
6236By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6237system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6238@code{set host-charset} command.
6239
6240@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6241set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
e33d66ec
EZ
6242indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6243@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6244list the host character sets it supports.
a0eb71c5
KB
6245
6246@item set charset @var{charset}
6247@kindex set charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6248Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6249above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6250@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6251for both host and target.
6252
a0eb71c5
KB
6253
6254@item show charset
a0eb71c5 6255@kindex show charset
b383017d 6256Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
e33d66ec
EZ
6257
6258@itemx show host-charset
a0eb71c5 6259@kindex show host-charset
b383017d 6260Show the name of the current host charset.
e33d66ec
EZ
6261
6262@itemx show target-charset
a0eb71c5 6263@kindex show target-charset
b383017d 6264Show the name of the current target charset.
a0eb71c5
KB
6265
6266@end table
6267
6268@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6269sets:
6270
6271@table @code
6272
6273@item ASCII
6274@cindex ASCII character set
6275Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6276character set.
6277
6278@item ISO-8859-1
6279@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6280@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
e33d66ec 6281The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
a0eb71c5
KB
6282characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6283this as its host character set.
6284
6285@item EBCDIC-US
6286@itemx IBM1047
6287@cindex EBCDIC character set
6288@cindex IBM1047 character set
6289Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6290mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6291@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6292
6293@end table
6294
6295Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6296GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6297encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6298
6299Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6300Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6301@file{charset-test.c}:
6302
6303@smallexample
6304#include <stdio.h>
6305
6306char ascii_hello[]
6307 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6308 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6309char ibm1047_hello[]
6310 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6311 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6312
6313main ()
6314@{
6315 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6316@}
10998722 6317@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6318
6319In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6320containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6321encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6322
6323We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6324
6325@smallexample
6326$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6327$ gdb -nw charset-test
6328GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6329Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6330@dots{}
b383017d 6331(gdb)
10998722 6332@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6333
6334We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6335@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6336strings:
6337
6338@smallexample
6339(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec 6340The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
b383017d 6341(gdb)
10998722 6342@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6343
6344For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6345initial character set:
6346@smallexample
e33d66ec 6347(gdb) set charset ASCII
a0eb71c5 6348(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec 6349The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
b383017d 6350(gdb)
10998722 6351@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6352
6353Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6354host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6355characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6356them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6357@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6358
6359@smallexample
6360(gdb) print ascii_hello
6361$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6362(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6363$2 = 72 'H'
b383017d 6364(gdb)
10998722 6365@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6366
6367@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6368literals you use in expressions:
6369
6370@smallexample
6371(gdb) print '+'
6372$3 = 43 '+'
b383017d 6373(gdb)
10998722 6374@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6375
6376The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6377character.
6378
6379@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6380target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6381character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6382
6383@smallexample
6384(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6385$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6386(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6387$5 = 200 '\310'
b383017d 6388(gdb)
10998722 6389@end smallexample
a0eb71c5 6390
e33d66ec 6391If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
a0eb71c5
KB
6392@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6393
6394@smallexample
6395(gdb) set target-charset
b383017d
RM
6396ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6397(gdb) set target-charset
10998722 6398@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6399
6400We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6401program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6402@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6403target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6404@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6405
6406@smallexample
e33d66ec 6407(gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
a0eb71c5 6408(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6409The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6410The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
a0eb71c5
KB
6411(gdb) print ascii_hello
6412$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6413(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6414$7 = 72 '\110'
6415(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6416$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6417(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6418$9 = 200 'H'
6419(gdb)
10998722 6420@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6421
6422As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6423string literals you use in expressions:
6424
6425@smallexample
6426(gdb) print '+'
6427$10 = 78 '+'
b383017d 6428(gdb)
10998722 6429@end smallexample
a0eb71c5 6430
e33d66ec 6431The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
a0eb71c5
KB
6432character.
6433
6434
e2e0bcd1
JB
6435@node Macros
6436@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6437
49efadf5 6438Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
e2e0bcd1
JB
6439``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6440@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6441the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6442where it was defined.
6443
6444You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6445with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6446include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6447with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6448
6449A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6450and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6451points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6452no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6453uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6454@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6455see @ref{List}.
6456
6457At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6458token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6459variable-arity macros.
6460
6461Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6462macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6463the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6464
6465@table @code
6466
6467@kindex macro expand
6468@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6469@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6470@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6471@item macro expand @var{expression}
6472@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6473Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6474@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6475not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6476it can be any string of tokens.
6477
6478@kindex macro expand-once
6479@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6480@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6481@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6482expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6483@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6484left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6485particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6486expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6487parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6488can be any string of tokens.
6489
475b0867 6490@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6491@cindex macro definition, showing
6492@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6493@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6494Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6495source location where that definition was established.
6496
6497@kindex macro define
6498@cindex user-defined macros
6499@cindex defining macros interactively
6500@cindex macros, user-defined
6501@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6502@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6503@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6504preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6505by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6506command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6507second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6508given in @var{arglist}.
6509
6510A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6511evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6512undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6513definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6514well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6515
6516@kindex macro undef
6517@item macro undef @var{macro}
6518@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6519definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6520definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6521above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6522debugged.
6523
6524@end table
6525
6526@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6527Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6528show our source files:
6529
6530@smallexample
6531$ cat sample.c
6532#include <stdio.h>
6533#include "sample.h"
6534
6535#define M 42
6536#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6537
6538main ()
6539@{
6540#define N 28
6541 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6542#undef N
6543 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6544#define N 1729
6545 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6546@}
6547$ cat sample.h
6548#define Q <
6549$
6550@end smallexample
6551
6552Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6553We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6554compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6555information.
6556
6557@smallexample
6558$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6559$
6560@end smallexample
6561
6562Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6563
6564@smallexample
6565$ gdb -nw sample
6566GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6567Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6568GDB is free software, @dots{}
6569(gdb)
6570@end smallexample
6571
6572We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6573program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6574to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6575
6576@smallexample
6577(gdb) list main
65783
65794 #define M 42
65805 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
65816
65827 main ()
65838 @{
65849 #define N 28
658510 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
658611 #undef N
658712 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6588(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6589Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6590#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6591(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6592Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6593 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6594#define Q <
6595(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6596expands to: (42 + 1)
6597(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6598expands to: once (M + 1)
b383017d 6599(gdb)
e2e0bcd1
JB
6600@end smallexample
6601
6602In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6603the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6604@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6605which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6606
6607Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6608the source line of the current stack frame:
6609
6610@smallexample
6611(gdb) break main
6612Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6613(gdb) run
b383017d 6614Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
e2e0bcd1
JB
6615
6616Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
661710 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
b383017d 6618(gdb)
e2e0bcd1
JB
6619@end smallexample
6620
6621At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6622
6623@smallexample
475b0867 6624(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6625Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6626#define N 28
6627(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6628expands to: 28 < 42
6629(gdb) print N Q M
6630$1 = 1
b383017d 6631(gdb)
e2e0bcd1
JB
6632@end smallexample
6633
6634As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6635give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6636thereof) in force at each point:
6637
6638@smallexample
6639(gdb) next
6640Hello, world!
664112 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6642(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6643The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6644at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6645(gdb) next
6646We're so creative.
664714 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6648(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6649Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6650#define N 1729
6651(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6652expands to: 1729 < 42
6653(gdb) print N Q M
6654$2 = 0
b383017d 6655(gdb)
e2e0bcd1
JB
6656@end smallexample
6657
6658
b37052ae
EZ
6659@node Tracepoints
6660@chapter Tracepoints
6661@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6662@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6663
6664@cindex tracepoints
6665In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6666the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6667anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6668depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6669might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6670fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6671to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6672
6673Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6674specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6675arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6676Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6677those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6678expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6679for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6680a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6681in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6682values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6683unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6684
6685The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6686targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6687to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6688stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6689tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6690
6691This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6692
6693@menu
b383017d
RM
6694* Set Tracepoints::
6695* Analyze Collected Data::
6696* Tracepoint Variables::
b37052ae
EZ
6697@end menu
6698
6699@node Set Tracepoints
6700@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6701
6702Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6703tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6704tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6705breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6706one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6707tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6708work on.
6709
6710For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6711of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6712it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6713local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6714commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6715tracepoint was hit.
6716
6717This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6718conditions and actions.
6719
6720@menu
b383017d
RM
6721* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6722* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6723* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6724* Tracepoint Actions::
6725* Listing Tracepoints::
6726* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
b37052ae
EZ
6727@end menu
6728
6729@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6730@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6731
6732@table @code
6733@cindex set tracepoint
6734@kindex trace
6735@item trace
6736The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6737Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6738the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6739defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6740debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6741program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6742doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6743cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6744running.
6745
6746Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6747
6748@smallexample
6749(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6750
6751(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6752
6753(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6754
6755(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6756
6757(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6758@end smallexample
6759
6760@noindent
6761You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6762
6763@vindex $tpnum
6764@cindex last tracepoint number
6765@cindex recent tracepoint number
6766@cindex tracepoint number
6767The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6768of the most recently set tracepoint.
6769
6770@kindex delete tracepoint
6771@cindex tracepoint deletion
6772@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6773Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6774default is to delete all tracepoints.
6775
6776Examples:
6777
6778@smallexample
6779(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6780
6781(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6782@end smallexample
6783
6784@noindent
6785You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6786@end table
6787
6788@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6789@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6790
6791@table @code
6792@kindex disable tracepoint
6793@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6794Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6795@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6796the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6797a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6798
6799@kindex enable tracepoint
6800@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6801Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6802tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6803run.
6804@end table
6805
6806@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6807@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6808
6809@table @code
6810@kindex passcount
6811@cindex tracepoint pass count
6812@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6813Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6814automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6815@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6816the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6817@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6818passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6819given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6820user.
6821
6822Examples:
6823
6824@smallexample
b383017d 6825(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6826cf00 6826@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6827
6828(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6829@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6830(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6831(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6832(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6833(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6834(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6835(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6836@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6837@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6838@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6839@end smallexample
6840@end table
6841
6842@node Tracepoint Actions
6843@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6844
6845@table @code
6846@kindex actions
6847@cindex tracepoint actions
6848@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6849This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6850tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6851specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6852recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6853@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6854actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6855terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6856far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6857@code{while-stepping}.
6858
6859@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6860To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6861and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6862
6863@smallexample
6864(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6865
6826cf00 6866(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6867
6826cf00 6868(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6869@end smallexample
6870
6871In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6872commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6873hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6874following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6875followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6876@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6877@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6878@code{end} command.
6879
6880@smallexample
6881(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6882(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6883Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6884> collect bar,baz
6885> collect $regs
6886> while-stepping 12
6887 > collect $fp, $sp
6888 > end
6889end
6890@end smallexample
6891
6892@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6893@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6894Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6895This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6896In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6897special arguments are supported:
6898
6899@table @code
6900@item $regs
6901collect all registers
6902
6903@item $args
6904collect all function arguments
6905
6906@item $locals
6907collect all local variables.
6908@end table
6909
6910You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6911with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6912arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6913
f5c37c66
EZ
6914The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6915particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6916
b37052ae
EZ
6917@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6918@item while-stepping @var{n}
6919Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6920new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6921followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6922its own @code{end} command):
6923
6924@smallexample
6925> while-stepping 12
6926 > collect $regs, myglobal
6927 > end
6928>
6929@end smallexample
6930
6931@noindent
6932You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6933@code{stepping}.
6934@end table
6935
6936@node Listing Tracepoints
6937@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6938
6939@table @code
6940@kindex info tracepoints
6941@cindex information about tracepoints
6942@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6943Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6944a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6945defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6946shown:
6947
6948@itemize @bullet
6949@item
6950its number
6951@item
6952whether it is enabled or disabled
6953@item
6954its address
6955@item
6956its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6957@item
6958its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6959@item
6960where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6961@item
6962its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6963@end itemize
6964
6965@smallexample
6966(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6967Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
69681 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
69692 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
69703 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6971(@value{GDBP})
6972@end smallexample
6973
6974@noindent
6975This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6976@end table
6977
6978@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6979@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6980
6981@table @code
6982@kindex tstart
6983@cindex start a new trace experiment
6984@cindex collected data discarded
6985@item tstart
6986This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6987begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6988the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6989experiment.
6990
6991@kindex tstop
6992@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6993@item tstop
6994This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6995stops collecting data.
6996
6997@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6998automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6999(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7000
7001@kindex tstatus
7002@cindex status of trace data collection
7003@cindex trace experiment, status of
7004@item tstatus
7005This command displays the status of the current trace data
7006collection.
7007@end table
7008
7009Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7010
7011@smallexample
7012(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7013(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7014Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7015> collect $regs,$locals,$args
7016> while-stepping 11
7017 > collect $regs
7018 > end
7019> end
7020(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7021 [time passes @dots{}]
7022(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7023@end smallexample
7024
7025
7026@node Analyze Collected Data
7027@section Using the collected data
7028
7029After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7030for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7031collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7032snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7033consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7034examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7035specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7036snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7037registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7038rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7039debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7040(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7041behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7042when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7043the buffer will fail.
7044
7045@menu
7046* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7047* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7048* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7049@end menu
7050
7051@node tfind
7052@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7053
7054@kindex tfind
7055@cindex select trace snapshot
7056@cindex find trace snapshot
7057The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7058@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7059counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7060snapshot is selected.
7061
7062Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7063
7064@table @code
7065@item tfind start
7066Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7067@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7068
7069@item tfind none
7070Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7071
7072@item tfind end
7073Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7074
7075@item tfind
7076No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7077
7078@item tfind -
7079Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7080retracing earlier steps.
7081
7082@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7083Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7084proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7085argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7086for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7087
7088@item tfind pc @var{addr}
7089Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7090program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7091snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7092snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7093
7094@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7095Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7096addresses.
7097
7098@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7099Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7100@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7101
7102@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7103Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7104the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7105that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7106trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7107next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7108@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7109stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7110@end table
7111
7112The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7113designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7114instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7115snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7116trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7117simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7118snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7119@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7120The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7121for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7122no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7123(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7124no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7125tracepoint as the current one.
7126
7127In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7128these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7129scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7130you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7131registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7132
7133@smallexample
7134(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7135(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7136> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7137 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7138> tfind
7139> end
7140
7141Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7142Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7143Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7144Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7145Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7146Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7147Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7148Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7149Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7150Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7151Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7152@end smallexample
7153
7154Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7155the buffer:
7156
7157@smallexample
7158(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7159(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7160> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7161> tfind line
7162> end
7163
7164Frame 0, X = 1
7165Frame 7, X = 2
7166Frame 13, X = 255
7167@end smallexample
7168
7169@node tdump
7170@subsection @code{tdump}
7171@kindex tdump
7172@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7173@cindex tracepoint data, display
7174
7175This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7176the current trace snapshot.
7177
7178@smallexample
7179(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7180(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7181Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7182> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7183> end
7184
7185(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7186
7187(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7188#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7189at gdb_test.c:444
7190444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7191
7192(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7193Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7194d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7195d1 0x18 24
7196d2 0x80 128
7197d3 0x33 51
7198d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7199d5 0x22 34
7200d6 0xe0 224
7201d7 0x380035 3670069
7202a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7203a1 0x3000668 50333288
7204a2 0x100 256
7205a3 0x322000 3284992
7206a4 0x3000698 50333336
7207a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7208fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7209sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7210ps 0x0 0
7211pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7212fpcontrol 0x0 0
7213fpstatus 0x0 0
7214fpiaddr 0x0 0
7215p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7216p1 = (void *) 0x11
7217p2 = (void *) 0x22
7218p3 = (void *) 0x33
7219p4 = (void *) 0x44
7220p5 = (void *) 0x55
7221p6 = (void *) 0x66
7222gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7223
7224(@value{GDBP})
7225@end smallexample
7226
7227@node save-tracepoints
7228@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7229@kindex save-tracepoints
7230@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7231
7232This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7233their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7234suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7235tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7236Files}).
7237
7238@node Tracepoint Variables
7239@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7240@cindex tracepoint variables
7241@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7242
7243@table @code
7244@vindex $trace_frame
7245@item (int) $trace_frame
7246The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7247snapshot is selected.
7248
7249@vindex $tracepoint
7250@item (int) $tracepoint
7251The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7252
7253@vindex $trace_line
7254@item (int) $trace_line
7255The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7256
7257@vindex $trace_file
7258@item (char []) $trace_file
7259The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7260
7261@vindex $trace_func
7262@item (char []) $trace_func
7263The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7264@end table
7265
7266Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7267use @code{output} instead.
7268
7269Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7270stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7271data.
7272
7273@smallexample
7274(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7275
7276(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7277> output $trace_file
7278> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7279> tfind
7280> end
7281@end smallexample
7282
df0cd8c5
JB
7283@node Overlays
7284@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7285@cindex overlays
7286
7287If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7288memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7289problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7290use overlays.
7291
7292@menu
7293* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7294* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7295* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7296 mapped by asking the inferior.
7297* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7298@end menu
7299
7300@node How Overlays Work
7301@section How Overlays Work
7302@cindex mapped overlays
7303@cindex unmapped overlays
7304@cindex load address, overlay's
7305@cindex mapped address
7306@cindex overlay area
7307
7308Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7309kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7310other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7311management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7312adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7313
7314One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7315independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7316@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7317their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7318instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7319largest overlay as well.
7320
7321Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7322overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7323for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7324there.
7325
c928edc0
AC
7326@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7327@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7328@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7329
474c8240 7330@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7331@group
c928edc0
AC
7332 Data Instruction Larger
7333Address Space Address Space Address Space
7334+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7335| | | | | |
7336+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7337| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7338| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7339| and heap | | | | | |
7340+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7341| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7342+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7343 | | | | | |
7344 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7345 address | | | | | |
7346 | overlay | <-' | | |
7347 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7348 | | <---. | | load address
7349 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7350 | | | |
7351 +-----------+ | |
7352 +-----------+
7353 | |
7354 +-----------+
7355
7356 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7357@end group
474c8240 7358@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7359
c928edc0
AC
7360The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7361and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7362its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7363Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7364may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7365data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7366program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7367program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7368
7369An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7370@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7371instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7372in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7373is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7374the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7375called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7376
7377Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7378program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7379global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7380
7381@itemize @bullet
7382
7383@item
7384Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7385must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7386return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7387overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7388
7389@item
7390If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7391will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7392your program's performance.
7393
7394@item
7395The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7396overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7397mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7398and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7399You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7400addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7401ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7402
7403@item
7404The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7405to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7406instruction and data spaces.
7407
7408@end itemize
7409
7410The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7411improved in many ways:
7412
7413@itemize @bullet
7414
7415@item
7416If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7417hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7418contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7419This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7420area in the usual way.
7421
7422@item
7423If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7424overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7425
7426@item
7427You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7428general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7429code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7430return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7431the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7432must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7433different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7434
7435@end itemize
7436
7437
7438@node Overlay Commands
7439@section Overlay Commands
7440
7441To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7442correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7443virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7444mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7445@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7446variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7447
7448@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7449you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7450
7451@table @code
7452@item overlay off
7453@kindex overlay off
7454Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7455disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7456always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7457overlay support is disabled.
7458
7459@item overlay manual
7460@kindex overlay manual
7461@cindex manual overlay debugging
7462Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7463relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7464using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7465commands described below.
7466
7467@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7468@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7469@kindex overlay map-overlay
7470@cindex map an overlay
7471Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7472be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7473overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7474functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7475that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7476@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7477
7478@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7479@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7480@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7481@cindex unmap an overlay
7482Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7483must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7484When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7485overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7486
7487@item overlay auto
7488@kindex overlay auto
7489Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7490consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7491to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7492Overlay Debugging}.
7493
7494@item overlay load-target
7495@itemx overlay load
7496@kindex overlay load-target
7497@cindex reloading the overlay table
7498Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7499re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7500stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7501overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7502useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7503
7504@item overlay list-overlays
7505@itemx overlay list
7506@cindex listing mapped overlays
7507Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7508addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7509
7510@end table
7511
7512Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7513of the function the address falls in:
7514
474c8240 7515@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7516(gdb) print main
7517$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7518@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7519@noindent
7520When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7521unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7522asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7523unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7524
474c8240 7525@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7526(gdb) overlay list
7527No sections are mapped.
7528(gdb) print foo
7529$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7530@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7531@noindent
7532When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7533name normally:
7534
474c8240 7535@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7536(gdb) overlay list
b383017d 7537Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
df0cd8c5
JB
7538 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7539(gdb) print foo
7540$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7541@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7542
7543When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7544address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7545overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7546@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7547code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7548
7549@itemize @bullet
7550@item
7551@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7552@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7553You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7554@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7555@item
7556@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7557unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7558overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7559you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7560breakpoints properly.
7561@end itemize
7562
7563
7564@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7565@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7566@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7567
7568@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7569are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7570inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7571@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7572looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7573current state of the overlays.
7574
7575Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7576@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7577
7578@table @asis
7579
7580@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7581This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7582
474c8240 7583@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7584struct
7585@{
7586 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7587 unsigned long vma;
7588
7589 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7590 unsigned long size;
7591
7592 /* The overlay's load address. */
7593 unsigned long lma;
7594
7595 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7596 zero otherwise. */
7597 unsigned long mapped;
7598@}
474c8240 7599@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7600
7601@item @code{_novlys}:
7602This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7603number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7604
7605@end table
7606
7607To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7608looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7609@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7610executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7611the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7612currently mapped.
7613
81d46470 7614In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7615@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7616will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7617calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7618will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7619are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
b383017d 7620in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
81d46470
MS
7621overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7622are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7623
7624@node Overlay Sample Program
7625@section Overlay Sample Program
7626@cindex overlay example program
7627
7628When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7629at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7630addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7631Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7632since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7633architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7634portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7635
7636However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7637program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7638suite. The program consists of the following files from
7639@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7640
7641@table @file
7642@item overlays.c
7643The main program file.
7644@item ovlymgr.c
7645A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7646@item foo.c
7647@itemx bar.c
7648@itemx baz.c
7649@itemx grbx.c
7650Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7651@item d10v.ld
7652@itemx m32r.ld
7653Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7654and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7655@end table
7656
7657You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7658cross-compiler like this:
7659
474c8240 7660@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7661$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7662$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7663$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7664$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7665$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7666$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7667$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7668 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7669@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7670
7671The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7672you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7673target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7674
7675
6d2ebf8b 7676@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7677@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7678@cindex languages
7679
c906108c
SS
7680Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7681rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7682dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7683Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7684represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7685@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7686
7687@cindex working language
7688Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7689allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7690native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7691consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7692language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7693language}.
7694
7695@menu
7696* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7697* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7698* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c 7699* Support:: Supported languages
4e562065 7700* Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
c906108c
SS
7701@end menu
7702
6d2ebf8b 7703@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7704@section Switching between source languages
7705
7706There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7707set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7708@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7709defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7710used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7711are printed, etc.
7712
7713In addition to the working language, every source file that
7714@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7715file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7716source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7717language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7718controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7719show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7720set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7721set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7722Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7723
7724This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7725as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7726another language. In that case, make the
7727program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7728@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7729program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7730
7731@menu
7732* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7733* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7734* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7735@end menu
7736
6d2ebf8b 7737@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7738@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7739
7740If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7741@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7742
7743@table @file
7744
7745@item .c
7746C source file
7747
7748@item .C
7749@itemx .cc
7750@itemx .cp
7751@itemx .cpp
7752@itemx .cxx
7753@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7754C@t{++} source file
c906108c 7755
b37303ee
AF
7756@item .m
7757Objective-C source file
7758
c906108c
SS
7759@item .f
7760@itemx .F
7761Fortran source file
7762
c906108c
SS
7763@item .mod
7764Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7765
7766@item .s
7767@itemx .S
7768Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7769@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7770@end table
7771
7772In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7773extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7774
6d2ebf8b 7775@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7776@subsection Setting the working language
7777
7778If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7779expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7780your program.
7781
7782@kindex set language
7783If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7784command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7785a language, such as
c906108c 7786@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7787For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7788
c906108c
SS
7789Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7790language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7791to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7792source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7793languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7794source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7795command such as:
7796
474c8240 7797@smallexample
c906108c 7798print a = b + c
474c8240 7799@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7800
7801@noindent
7802might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7803@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7804printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7805@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7806
6d2ebf8b 7807@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7808@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7809
7810To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7811@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7812then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7813frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7814working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7815frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7816or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7817does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7818not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7819
7820This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7821entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7822written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7823a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7824case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7825
6d2ebf8b 7826@node Show
c906108c 7827@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7828
7829The following commands help you find out which language is the
7830working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7831
7832@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7833@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7834@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7835@table @code
7836@item show language
7837Display the current working language. This is the
7838language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7839build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7840
7841@item info frame
5d161b24 7842Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7843working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7844@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7845information listed here.
7846
7847@item info source
7848Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7849@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7850information listed here.
7851@end table
7852
7853In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7854not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7855with a language explicitly:
7856
7857@kindex set extension-language
7858@kindex info extensions
7859@table @code
7860@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7861Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7862the source language @var{language}.
7863
7864@item info extensions
7865List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7866@end table
7867
6d2ebf8b 7868@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7869@section Type and range checking
7870
7871@quotation
7872@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7873checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7874section documents the intended facilities.
7875@end quotation
7876@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7877
7878Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7879errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7880checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7881sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7882these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7883by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7884errors when your program is running.
7885
7886@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7887Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7888can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7889the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7890@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7891your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7892for the default settings of supported languages.
7893
7894@menu
7895* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7896* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7897@end menu
7898
7899@cindex type checking
7900@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7901@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7902@subsection An overview of type checking
7903
7904Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7905arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7906otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7907errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7908
7909@smallexample
79101 + 2 @result{} 3
7911@exdent but
7912@error{} 1 + 2.3
7913@end smallexample
7914
7915The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7916type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7917
5d161b24
DB
7918For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7919@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7920to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7921or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7922but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7923these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7924also issues a warning.
7925
5d161b24
DB
7926Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7927related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7928For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7929a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7930with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7931the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7932
7933Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7934instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7935operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7936represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7937operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7938details on specific languages.
7939
7940@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7941
d4f3574e 7942@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7943@kindex set check type
7944@kindex show check type
7945@table @code
7946@item set check type auto
7947Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7948@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7949each language.
7950
7951@item set check type on
7952@itemx set check type off
7953Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7954current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7955match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7956evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7957message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7958
7959@item set check type warn
7960Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7961evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7962be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7963numbers and structures.
7964
7965@item show type
5d161b24 7966Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7967is setting it automatically.
7968@end table
7969
7970@cindex range checking
7971@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7972@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7973@subsection An overview of range checking
7974
7975In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7976bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7977checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7978computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7979not exceed the bounds of the array.
7980
7981For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7982@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7983always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7984warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7985
7986A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7987array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7988of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7989error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7990result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7991the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7992
474c8240 7993@smallexample
c906108c 7994@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7995@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7996
7997This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7998specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7999Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8000
8001@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8002
d4f3574e 8003@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
8004@kindex set check range
8005@kindex show check range
8006@table @code
8007@item set check range auto
8008Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8009@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8010each language.
8011
8012@item set check range on
8013@itemx set check range off
8014Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8015current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
8016match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8017then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
8018
8019@item set check range warn
8020Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8021but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8022expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8023memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8024systems).
8025
8026@item show range
8027Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8028being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8029@end table
c906108c 8030
6d2ebf8b 8031@node Support
c906108c 8032@section Supported languages
c906108c 8033
b37303ee 8034@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 8035@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
8036Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8037language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8038and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8039,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8040language.
8041
8042The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8043supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8044tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8045@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8046formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8047books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8048language reference or tutorial.
8049
c906108c 8050@menu
b37303ee 8051* C:: C and C@t{++}
b383017d 8052* Objective-C:: Objective-C
b37303ee 8053* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
8054@end menu
8055
6d2ebf8b 8056@node C
b37052ae 8057@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8058
b37052ae
EZ
8059@cindex C and C@t{++}
8060@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 8061
b37052ae 8062Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
8063to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8064together.
8065
41afff9a
EZ
8066@cindex C@t{++}
8067@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
8068@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8069The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8070compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8071effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8072C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8073compiler (@code{aCC}).
8074
0179ffac
DC
8075For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8076format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8077format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8078command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8079@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8080CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
c906108c 8081
c906108c 8082@menu
b37052ae
EZ
8083* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8084* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8085* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8086* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8087* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 8088* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 8089* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8090@end menu
c906108c 8091
6d2ebf8b 8092@node C Operators
b37052ae 8093@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 8094
b37052ae 8095@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
8096
8097Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8098@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 8099often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 8100
b37052ae 8101For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
8102
8103@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 8104
c906108c 8105@item
c906108c 8106@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 8107specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
8108
8109@item
d4f3574e
SS
8110@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8111@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
8112
8113@item
53a5351d 8114@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
8115
8116@item
8117@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 8118
c906108c
SS
8119@end itemize
8120
8121@noindent
8122The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8123in order of increasing precedence:
8124
8125@table @code
8126@item ,
8127The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8128are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8129expression being the last expression evaluated.
8130
8131@item =
8132Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8133assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8134
8135@item @var{op}=
8136Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8137and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 8138@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
8139@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8140@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8141
8142@item ?:
8143The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8144of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8145integral type.
8146
8147@item ||
8148Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8149
8150@item &&
8151Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8152
8153@item |
8154Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8155
8156@item ^
8157Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8158
8159@item &
8160Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8161
8162@item ==@r{, }!=
8163Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8164expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8165
8166@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8167Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8168Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8169and non-zero for true.
8170
8171@item <<@r{, }>>
8172left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8173
8174@item @@
8175The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8176
8177@item +@r{, }-
8178Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8179pointer types.
8180
8181@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8182Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8183defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8184integral types.
8185
8186@item ++@r{, }--
8187Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8188operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8189when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8190operation takes place.
8191
8192@item *
8193Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8194@code{++}.
8195
8196@item &
8197Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8198
b37052ae
EZ
8199For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8200allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 8201(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 8202where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 8203stored.
c906108c
SS
8204
8205@item -
8206Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8207precedence as @code{++}.
8208
8209@item !
8210Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8211@code{++}.
8212
8213@item ~
8214Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8215@code{++}.
8216
8217
8218@item .@r{, }->
8219Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8220@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8221pointer based on the stored type information.
8222Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8223
c906108c
SS
8224@item .*@r{, }->*
8225Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
8226
8227@item []
8228Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8229@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8230
8231@item ()
8232Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8233
c906108c 8234@item ::
b37052ae 8235C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 8236and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
8237
8238@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
8239Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8240(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8241above.
c906108c
SS
8242@end table
8243
c906108c
SS
8244If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8245attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8246predefined meaning.
c906108c 8247
c906108c 8248@menu
5d161b24 8249* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
8250@end menu
8251
6d2ebf8b 8252@node C Constants
b37052ae 8253@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 8254
b37052ae 8255@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 8256
b37052ae 8257@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 8258following ways:
c906108c
SS
8259
8260@itemize @bullet
8261@item
8262Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8263specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8264by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8265@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8266@code{long} value.
8267
8268@item
8269Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8270point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8271exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8272@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8273sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8274A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8275@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8276the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8277a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8278constant.
c906108c
SS
8279
8280@item
8281Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8282integral equivalents.
8283
8284@item
8285Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8286(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8287(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8288be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8289the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8290of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8291@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8292@samp{\n} for newline.
8293
8294@item
96a2c332
SS
8295String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8296double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8297above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8298a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8299characters.
c906108c
SS
8300
8301@item
8302Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8303to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8304
8305@item
8306Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8307and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8308integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8309and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8310@end itemize
8311
c906108c 8312@menu
5d161b24
DB
8313* C plus plus expressions::
8314* C Defaults::
8315* C Checks::
c906108c 8316
5d161b24 8317* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8318@end menu
8319
6d2ebf8b 8320@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8321@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8322
8323@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8324@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8325
0179ffac
DC
8326@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8327@cindex C@t{++} compilers
8328@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8329@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
c906108c 8330@quotation
b37052ae 8331@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
0179ffac
DC
8332proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8333works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8334@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8335@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8336stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8337stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8338specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8339are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8340C@t{++} code.
c906108c 8341@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8342
8343@enumerate
8344
8345@cindex member functions
8346@item
8347Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8348
474c8240 8349@smallexample
c906108c 8350count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8351@end smallexample
c906108c 8352
41afff9a 8353@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8354@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8355@item
8356While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8357expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8358that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8359pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8360
c906108c 8361@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8362@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8363@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8364@item
8365You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8366call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8367perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8368calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8369in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8370default arguments.
8371
8372It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8373promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8374class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8375functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8376number of function arguments.
8377
8378Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8379@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8380,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8381
d4f3574e 8382You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8383explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8384@smallexample
8385p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8386@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8387
c906108c 8388The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8389see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8390
c906108c
SS
8391@cindex reference declarations
8392@item
b37052ae
EZ
8393@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8394them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8395dereferenced.
8396
8397In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8398reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8399avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8400The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8401you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8402
8403@item
b37052ae 8404@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8405expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8406one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8407necessary, for example in an expression like
8408@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8409resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8410debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8411@end enumerate
8412
b37052ae 8413In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8414calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8415objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8416invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8417
6d2ebf8b 8418@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8419@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8420
b37052ae 8421@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8422
c906108c
SS
8423If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8424both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8425C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8426selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8427
8428If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8429recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8430@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8431these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8432@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8433for further details.
8434
c906108c
SS
8435@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8436@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8437@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8438
6d2ebf8b 8439@node C Checks
b37052ae 8440@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8441
b37052ae 8442@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8443
b37052ae 8444By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8445is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8446considers two variables type equivalent if:
8447
8448@itemize @bullet
8449@item
8450The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8451enumerated tag.
8452
8453@item
8454The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8455declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8456
8457@ignore
8458@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8459@c FIXME--beers?
8460@item
8461The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8462declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8463compilers.)
8464@end ignore
8465@end itemize
8466
8467Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8468indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8469that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8470
6d2ebf8b 8471@node Debugging C
c906108c 8472@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8473
8474The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8475the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8476inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8477appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8478
8479The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8480with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8481,Expressions}.
8482
c906108c 8483@menu
5d161b24 8484* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8485@end menu
8486
6d2ebf8b 8487@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8488@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8489
b37052ae 8490@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8491
b37052ae
EZ
8492Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8493designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8494
8495@table @code
8496@cindex break in overloaded functions
8497@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8498When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8499@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8500you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8501
b37052ae 8502@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8503@item rbreak @var{regex}
8504Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8505breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8506classes.
8507@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8508
b37052ae 8509@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8510@item catch throw
8511@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8512Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8513Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8514
8515@cindex inheritance
8516@item ptype @var{typename}
8517Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8518@var{typename}.
8519@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8520
b37052ae 8521@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8522@item set print demangle
8523@itemx show print demangle
8524@itemx set print asm-demangle
8525@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8526Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8527displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8528@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8529
8530@item set print object
8531@itemx show print object
8532Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8533@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8534
8535@item set print vtbl
8536@itemx show print vtbl
8537Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8538@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8539(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8540ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8541
8542@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8543@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8544@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8545Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8546is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8547and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8548using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8549expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8550message.
8551
8552@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8553Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8554overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8555chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8556symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8557overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8558searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8559argument types.
c906108c
SS
8560
8561@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8562You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8563the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8564@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8565also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8566available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8567@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8568@end table
c906108c 8569
b37303ee
AF
8570@node Objective-C
8571@subsection Objective-C
8572
8573@cindex Objective-C
8574This section provides information about some commands and command
8575options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.
8576
8577@menu
b383017d
RM
8578* Method Names in Commands::
8579* The Print Command with Objective-C::
b37303ee
AF
8580@end menu
8581
8582@node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
8583@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
8584
8585The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
8586names as line specifications:
8587
8588@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
8589@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
8590@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
8591@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
8592@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
8593@itemize
8594@item @code{clear}
8595@item @code{break}
8596@item @code{info line}
8597@item @code{jump}
8598@item @code{list}
8599@end itemize
8600
8601A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
8602
8603@smallexample
8604-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
8605@end smallexample
8606
c552b3bb
JM
8607where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
8608plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
8609name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
8610brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
8611source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
8612instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
8613debugged, enter:
b37303ee
AF
8614
8615@smallexample
8616break -[Fruit create]
8617@end smallexample
8618
8619To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
8620enter:
8621
8622@smallexample
8623list +[NSText initialize]
8624@end smallexample
8625
c552b3bb
JM
8626In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
8627required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
8628sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
8629is also possible to specify just a method name:
b37303ee
AF
8630
8631@smallexample
8632break create
8633@end smallexample
8634
8635You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
8636your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
8637you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
8638method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
8639none apply.
8640
8641As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
8642@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
8643
8644@smallexample
8645clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
8646@end smallexample
8647
8648@node The Print Command with Objective-C
8649@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
c552b3bb
JM
8650@kindex print-object
8651@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
b37303ee 8652
c552b3bb 8653The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
b37303ee
AF
8654
8655@smallexample
c552b3bb 8656print -[@var{object} hash]
b37303ee
AF
8657@end smallexample
8658
8659@cindex print an Objective-C object description
c552b3bb
JM
8660@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
8661@noindent
8662will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
8663and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
8664@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
8665the description of an object. However, this command may only work
8666with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
8667function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
b37303ee
AF
8668
8669@node Modula-2, , Objective-C, Support
c906108c 8670@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8671
d4f3574e 8672@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8673
8674The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8675output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8676developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8677attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8678to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8679table.
8680
8681@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8682@menu
8683* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8684* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8685* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8686* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8687* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8688* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8689* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8690* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8691@end menu
8692
6d2ebf8b 8693@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8694@subsubsection Operators
8695@cindex Modula-2 operators
8696
8697Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8698@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8699often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8700following definitions hold:
8701
8702@itemize @bullet
8703
8704@item
8705@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8706their subranges.
8707
8708@item
8709@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8710
8711@item
8712@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8713
8714@item
8715@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8716@var{type}}.
8717
8718@item
8719@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8720
8721@item
8722@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8723
8724@item
8725@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8726@end itemize
8727
8728@noindent
8729The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8730increasing precedence:
8731
8732@table @code
8733@item ,
8734Function argument or array index separator.
8735
8736@item :=
8737Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8738@var{value}.
8739
8740@item <@r{, }>
8741Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8742types.
8743
8744@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8745Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8746on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8747set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8748
8749@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8750Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8751Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8752available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8753comment character.
8754
8755@item IN
8756Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8757Same precedence as @code{<}.
8758
8759@item OR
8760Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8761
8762@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8763Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8764
8765@item @@
8766The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8767
8768@item +@r{, }-
8769Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8770and difference on set types.
8771
8772@item *
8773Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8774on set types.
8775
8776@item /
8777Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8778types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8779
8780@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8781Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8782precedence as @code{*}.
8783
8784@item -
8785Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8786
8787@item ^
8788Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8789
8790@item NOT
8791Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8792@code{^}.
8793
8794@item .
8795@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8796precedence as @code{^}.
8797
8798@item []
8799Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8800
8801@item ()
8802Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8803as @code{^}.
8804
8805@item ::@r{, }.
8806@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8807@end table
8808
8809@quotation
8810@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8811treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8812@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8813@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8814@end quotation
8815
cb51c4e0 8816
6d2ebf8b 8817@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8818@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8819@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8820
8821Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8822In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8823
8824@table @var
8825
8826@item a
8827represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8828
8829@item c
8830represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8831
8832@item i
8833represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8834
8835@item m
8836represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8837same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8838be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8839
8840@item n
8841represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8842
8843@item r
8844represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8845
8846@item t
8847represents a type.
8848
8849@item v
8850represents a variable.
8851
8852@item x
8853represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8854explanation of the function for details.
8855@end table
8856
8857All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8858
8859@table @code
8860@item ABS(@var{n})
8861Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8862
8863@item CAP(@var{c})
8864If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8865equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8866
8867@item CHR(@var{i})
8868Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8869
8870@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8871Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8872
8873@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8874Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8875new value.
8876
8877@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8878Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8879set.
8880
8881@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8882Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8883
8884@item HIGH(@var{a})
8885Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8886
8887@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8888Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8889
8890@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8891Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8892new value.
8893
8894@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8895Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8896there. Returns the new set.
8897
8898@item MAX(@var{t})
8899Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8900
8901@item MIN(@var{t})
8902Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8903
8904@item ODD(@var{i})
8905Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8906
8907@item ORD(@var{x})
8908Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8909value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8910@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8911integral, character and enumerated types.
8912
8913@item SIZE(@var{x})
8914Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8915
8916@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8917Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8918
8919@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8920Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8921@end table
8922
8923@quotation
8924@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8925@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8926an error.
8927@end quotation
8928
8929@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8930@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8931@subsubsection Constants
8932
8933@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8934ways:
8935
8936@itemize @bullet
8937
8938@item
8939Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8940expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8941rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8942trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8943
8944@item
8945Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8946decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8947then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8948@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8949digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8950digits.
8951
8952@item
8953Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8954like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8955also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8956followed by a @samp{C}.
8957
8958@item
8959String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8960pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8961Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8962Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8963sequences.
8964
8965@item
8966Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8967
8968@item
8969Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8970@code{FALSE}.
8971
8972@item
8973Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8974
8975@item
8976Set constants are not yet supported.
8977@end itemize
8978
6d2ebf8b 8979@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8980@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8981@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8982
8983If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8984both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8985Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8986selected the working language.
8987
8988If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8989code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8990working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8991the language automatically}, for further details.
8992
6d2ebf8b 8993@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8994@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8995@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8996
8997A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8998This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8999
9000@itemize @bullet
9001@item
9002Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
9003integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
9004debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
9005pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
9006through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
9007returned a pointer.)
9008
9009@item
9010C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
9011non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
9012escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
9013printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
9014
9015@item
9016The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
9017argument.
9018
9019@item
9020All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
9021@end itemize
9022
6d2ebf8b 9023@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
9024@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
9025@cindex Modula-2 checks
9026
9027@quotation
9028@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
9029range checking.
9030@end quotation
9031@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
9032
9033@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
9034
9035@itemize @bullet
9036@item
9037They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
9038@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
9039
9040@item
9041They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
9042@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
9043@end itemize
9044
9045As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
9046whose types are not equivalent is an error.
9047
9048Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9049index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
9050
6d2ebf8b 9051@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
9052@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9053@cindex scope
41afff9a 9054@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
9055@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
9056@ifinfo
41afff9a 9057@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
9058@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
9059@end ifinfo
9060@iftex
41afff9a 9061@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
9062@end iftex
9063
9064There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
9065(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
9066similar syntax:
9067
474c8240 9068@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9069
9070@var{module} . @var{id}
9071@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 9072@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9073
9074@noindent
9075where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
9076@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
9077identifier within your program, except another module.
9078
9079Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
9080specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
9081found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
9082enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
9083
9084Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
9085the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
9086definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
9087an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
9088module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
9089@var{module}.
9090
6d2ebf8b 9091@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
9092@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9093
9094Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
9095Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 9096specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 9097@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 9098apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
9099analogue in Modula-2.
9100
9101The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 9102with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 9103intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 9104created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 9105address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 9106@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
9107
9108@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
9109In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
9110interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 9111
4e562065
JB
9112@node Unsupported languages
9113@section Unsupported languages
9114
9115@cindex unsupported languages
9116@cindex minimal language
9117In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
9118@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
9119It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
9120of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
9121This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
9122an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
9123
9124If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
9125select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
9126language.
9127
6d2ebf8b 9128@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
9129@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9130
d4f3574e 9131The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
9132symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
9133program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
9134does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
9135program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
9136(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
9137file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9138
9139@cindex symbol names
9140@cindex names of symbols
9141@cindex quoting names
9142Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
9143characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
9144most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
9145source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
9146are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
9147ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
9148@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
9149@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
9150
474c8240 9151@smallexample
c906108c 9152p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 9153@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9154
9155@noindent
9156looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
9157
9158@table @code
9159@kindex info address
b37052ae 9160@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
9161@item info address @var{symbol}
9162Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
9163variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
9164local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
9165is always stored.
9166
9167Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
9168at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
9169the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9170
3d67e040 9171@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 9172@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
9173@item info symbol @var{addr}
9174Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9175If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9176nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9177
474c8240 9178@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9179(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9180_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 9181@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9182
9183@noindent
9184This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9185it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9186
c906108c 9187@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
9188@item whatis @var{expr}
9189Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
9190actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9191assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9192@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9193
9194@item whatis
9195Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9196
9197@kindex ptype
9198@item ptype @var{typename}
9199Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
9200the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9201@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9202@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 9203
d4f3574e 9204@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 9205@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 9206Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
9207differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9208of just the name of the type.
9209
9210For example, for this variable declaration:
9211
474c8240 9212@smallexample
c906108c 9213struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 9214@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9215
9216@noindent
9217the two commands give this output:
9218
474c8240 9219@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9220@group
9221(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9222type = struct complex
9223(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9224type = struct complex @{
9225 double real;
9226 double imag;
9227@}
9228@end group
474c8240 9229@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9230
9231@noindent
9232As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9233the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9234
9235@kindex info types
9236@item info types @var{regexp}
9237@itemx info types
d4f3574e 9238Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
9239(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9240complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9241@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 9242names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
9243information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9244
9245This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9246@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9247lists all source files where a type is defined.
9248
b37052ae
EZ
9249@kindex info scope
9250@cindex local variables
9251@item info scope @var{addr}
9252List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9253accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9254preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9255scope defined by that location. For example:
9256
9257@smallexample
9258(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9259Scope for command_line_handler:
9260Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9261Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9262Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9263Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9264Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9265Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9266Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9267@end smallexample
9268
f5c37c66
EZ
9269@noindent
9270This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9271during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9272collect}.
9273
c906108c
SS
9274@kindex info source
9275@item info source
919d772c
JB
9276Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9277the function containing the current point of execution:
9278@itemize @bullet
9279@item
9280the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9281@item
9282the directory it was compiled in,
9283@item
9284its length, in lines,
9285@item
9286which programming language it is written in,
9287@item
9288whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9289if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9290@item
9291whether the debugging information includes information about
9292preprocessor macros.
9293@end itemize
9294
c906108c
SS
9295
9296@kindex info sources
9297@item info sources
9298Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9299debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9300have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9301
9302@kindex info functions
9303@item info functions
9304Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9305
9306@item info functions @var{regexp}
9307Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9308whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9309Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9310include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
b383017d
RM
9311start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9312that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
1c5dfdad 9313@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
9314
9315@kindex info variables
9316@item info variables
9317Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 9318outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
9319
9320@item info variables @var{regexp}
9321Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9322variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9323@var{regexp}.
9324
b37303ee
AF
9325@kindex info classes
9326@item info classes
9327@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
9328Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
9329(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9330expression.
9331
9332@kindex info selectors
9333@item info selectors
9334@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
9335Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
9336(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9337expression.
9338
c906108c
SS
9339@ignore
9340This was never implemented.
9341@kindex info methods
9342@item info methods
9343@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9344The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
9345methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9346specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9347C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
9348from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9349@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9350which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9351@end ignore
9352
c906108c
SS
9353@cindex reloading symbols
9354Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
9355be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9356in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9357running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9358@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
9359
9360@table @code
9361@kindex set symbol-reloading
9362@item set symbol-reloading on
9363Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9364object file with a particular name is seen again.
9365
9366@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
9367Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9368same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9369running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9370should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9371may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9372several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9373name.
c906108c
SS
9374
9375@kindex show symbol-reloading
9376@item show symbol-reloading
9377Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9378@end table
c906108c 9379
c906108c
SS
9380@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9381@item set opaque-type-resolution on
9382Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9383declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9384@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9385source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9386another source file. The default is on.
9387
9388A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9389the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9390
9391@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9392Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9393is printed as follows:
9394@smallexample
9395@{<no data fields>@}
9396@end smallexample
9397
9398@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9399@item show opaque-type-resolution
9400Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9401
9402@kindex maint print symbols
9403@cindex symbol dump
9404@kindex maint print psymbols
9405@cindex partial symbol dump
9406@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9407@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9408@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9409Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9410These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9411symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9412symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9413collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9414only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9415command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9416use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9417symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9418files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9419@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9420required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9421@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9422@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
44ea7b70 9423
5e7b2f39
JB
9424@kindex maint info symtabs
9425@kindex maint info psymtabs
44ea7b70
JB
9426@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9427@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9428@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9429@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
5e7b2f39
JB
9430@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9431@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
44ea7b70
JB
9432
9433List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9434structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9435given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9436copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9437structure in more detail. For example:
9438
9439@smallexample
5e7b2f39 9440(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
44ea7b70
JB
9441@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9442 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
b383017d 9443 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
44ea7b70
JB
9444 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9445 readin no
9446 fullname (null)
9447 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9448 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9449 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9450 dependencies (none)
9451 @}
9452@}
5e7b2f39 9453(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
44ea7b70
JB
9454(@value{GDBP})
9455@end smallexample
9456@noindent
9457We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9458the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9459and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9460If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9461read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9462
9463@smallexample
9464(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9465Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9466line 1574.
5e7b2f39 9467(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
b383017d 9468@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
44ea7b70 9469 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
b383017d 9470 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
44ea7b70
JB
9471 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9472 dirname (null)
9473 fullname (null)
9474 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9475 debugformat DWARF 2
9476 @}
9477@}
b383017d 9478(@value{GDBP})
44ea7b70 9479@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9480@end table
9481
44ea7b70 9482
6d2ebf8b 9483@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9484@chapter Altering Execution
9485
9486Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9487find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9488correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9489experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9490program.
9491
9492For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9493locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9494address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9495
9496@menu
9497* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9498* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9499* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9500* Returning:: Returning from a function
9501* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9502* Patching:: Patching your program
9503@end menu
9504
6d2ebf8b 9505@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9506@section Assignment to variables
9507
9508@cindex assignment
9509@cindex setting variables
9510To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9511@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9512
474c8240 9513@smallexample
c906108c 9514print x=4
474c8240 9515@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9516
9517@noindent
9518stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9519value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9520@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9521information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9522
9523@kindex set variable
9524@cindex variables, setting
9525If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9526@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9527really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9528not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9529,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9530
c906108c
SS
9531If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9532appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9533variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9534to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9535program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9536a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9537command @code{set width}:
9538
474c8240 9539@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9540(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9541type = double
9542(@value{GDBP}) p width
9543$4 = 13
9544(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9545Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9546@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9547
9548@noindent
9549The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9550order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9551
474c8240 9552@smallexample
c906108c 9553(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9554@end smallexample
53a5351d 9555
c906108c
SS
9556Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9557with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9558@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9559your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9560to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9561the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9562
474c8240 9563@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9564@group
9565(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9566type = double
9567(@value{GDBP}) p g
9568$1 = 1
9569(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9570(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9571$2 = 1
9572(@value{GDBP}) r
9573The program being debugged has been started already.
9574Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9575Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9576"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9577 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9578(@value{GDBP}) show g
9579The current BFD target is "=4".
9580@end group
474c8240 9581@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9582
9583@noindent
9584The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9585@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9586@code{g}, use
9587
474c8240 9588@smallexample
c906108c 9589(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9590@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9591
9592@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9593freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9594and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9595same length or shorter.
9596@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9597@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9598
9599To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9600construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9601(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9602to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9603and representation in memory), and
9604
474c8240 9605@smallexample
c906108c 9606set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9607@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9608
9609@noindent
9610stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9611
6d2ebf8b 9612@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9613@section Continuing at a different address
9614
9615Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9616it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9617an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9618
9619@table @code
9620@kindex jump
9621@item jump @var{linespec}
9622Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9623immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9624source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9625@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9626in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9627breakpoints}.
9628
9629The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9630the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9631register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9632a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9633be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9634of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9635confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9636executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9637well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9638
9639@item jump *@var{address}
9640Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9641@end table
9642
c906108c 9643@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9644On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9645command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9646difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9647changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9648example,
c906108c 9649
474c8240 9650@smallexample
c906108c 9651set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9652@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9653
9654@noindent
9655makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9656address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9657@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9658
9659The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9660up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9661that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9662detail.
9663
c906108c 9664@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9665@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9666@section Giving your program a signal
9667
9668@table @code
9669@kindex signal
9670@item signal @var{signal}
9671Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9672signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9673signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9674SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9675
9676Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9677giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9678a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9679@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9680signal.
9681
9682@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9683after executing the command.
9684@end table
9685@c @end group
9686
9687Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9688@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9689causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9690the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9691passes the signal directly to your program.
9692
c906108c 9693
6d2ebf8b 9694@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9695@section Returning from a function
9696
9697@table @code
9698@cindex returning from a function
9699@kindex return
9700@item return
9701@itemx return @var{expression}
9702You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9703command. If you give an
9704@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9705value.
9706@end table
9707
9708When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9709(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9710discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9711be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9712
9713This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9714frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9715innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9716specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9717of functions.
9718
9719The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9720program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9721returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9722and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9723selected stack frame returns naturally.
9724
6d2ebf8b 9725@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9726@section Calling program functions
9727
9728@cindex calling functions
9729@kindex call
9730@table @code
9731@item call @var{expr}
9732Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9733returned values.
9734@end table
9735
9736You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9737execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9738with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9739is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9740
6d2ebf8b 9741@node Patching
c906108c 9742@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9743
c906108c
SS
9744@cindex patching binaries
9745@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9746@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9747
7a292a7a
SS
9748By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9749executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9750alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9751patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9752
9753If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9754explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9755want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9756repairs.
9757
9758@table @code
9759@kindex set write
9760@item set write on
9761@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9762If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9763core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9764off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9765
9766If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9767@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9768write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9769
9770@item show write
9771@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9772Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9773as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9774@end table
9775
6d2ebf8b 9776@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9777@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9778
7a292a7a
SS
9779@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9780both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9781program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9782@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9783
9784@menu
9785* Files:: Commands to specify files
5b5d99cf 9786* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
c906108c
SS
9787* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9788@end menu
9789
6d2ebf8b 9790@node Files
c906108c 9791@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9792
7a292a7a 9793@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9794@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9795
9796You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9797way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9798@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9799Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9800
9801Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9802@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9803a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9804to specify new files are useful.
9805
9806@table @code
9807@cindex executable file
9808@kindex file
9809@item file @var{filename}
9810Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9811symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9812executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9813directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9814@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9815directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9816to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9817and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9818
6d2ebf8b 9819On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9820@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9821@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9822@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9823descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9824(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9825@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9826for more information.
c906108c
SS
9827
9828@item file
9829@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9830has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9831
9832@kindex exec-file
9833@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9834Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9835in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9836if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9837discard information on the executable file.
9838
9839@kindex symbol-file
9840@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9841Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9842searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9843table and program to run from the same file.
9844
9845@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9846program's symbol table.
9847
5d161b24 9848The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9849of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9850auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9851the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9852the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9853
9854@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9855executing it once.
9856
9857When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9858understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9859generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9860other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9861Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9862using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9863optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9864
9865For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9866using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9867symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9868quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9869details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9870
9871The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9872start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9873occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9874file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9875pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9876warnings and messages}.)
9877
c906108c
SS
9878We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9879symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9880symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9881still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9882in stabs format.
9883
9884@kindex readnow
9885@cindex reading symbols immediately
9886@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9887@kindex mapped
9888@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9889@cindex saving symbol table
9890@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9891@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9892You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9893tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9894load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9895entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9896
c906108c
SS
9897If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9898@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9899cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9900file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9901from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9902than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9903program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9904starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9905
9906You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9907file has all the symbol information for your program.
9908
9909The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9910@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9911than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9912it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9913needed.
9914
9915The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9916@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9917symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9918
9919@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9920@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9921@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9922@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9923@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9924@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9925@c files.
9926
9927@kindex core
9928@kindex core-file
9929@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9930Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9931of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9932address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9933executable file itself for other parts.
9934
9935@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9936to be used.
9937
9938Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9939under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9940wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9941the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9942(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9943
c906108c
SS
9944@kindex add-symbol-file
9945@cindex dynamic linking
9946@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9947@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9948@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9949The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9950information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9951when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9952into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9953address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9954this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9955of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9956section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9957@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9958
9959The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9960originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9961@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9962thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9963instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9964
17d9d558
JB
9965@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9966@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9967@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9968@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9969@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9970Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9971executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9972relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9973information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9974
9975@itemize @bullet
9976@item
9977the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9978that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9979@item
9980every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9981been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9982@item
9983you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9984provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9985@end itemize
9986
9987@noindent
9988Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9989relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9990typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9991important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
49efadf5 9992procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17d9d558
JB
9993assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9994general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9995relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9996as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9997way.
9998
c906108c
SS
9999@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10000
10001You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
10002the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
10003table information for @var{filename}.
10004
10005@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
10006@item add-shared-symbol-file
10007The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
10008operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
10009shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 10010@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 10011
c906108c
SS
10012@kindex section
10013@item section
5d161b24
DB
10014The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
10015the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
10016section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
10017specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
10018separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
10019the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
10020
10021@kindex info files
10022@kindex info target
10023@item info files
10024@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
10025@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
10026current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
10027including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
10028use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
10029command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
10030current ones.
10031
fe95c787
MS
10032@kindex maint info sections
10033@item maint info sections
10034Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
10035is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
10036displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
10037offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
10038@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
10039may be arbitrarily combined):
10040
10041@table @code
10042@item ALLOBJ
10043Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
10044@item @var{sections}
6600abed 10045Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
10046@item @var{section-flags}
10047Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
10048The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
10049@table @code
10050@item ALLOC
10051Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
10052Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
10053@item LOAD
10054Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
10055Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
10056@item RELOC
10057Section needs to be relocated before loading.
10058@item READONLY
10059Section cannot be modified by the child process.
10060@item CODE
10061Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 10062@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
10063Section contains data only (no executable code).
10064@item ROM
10065Section will reside in ROM.
10066@item CONSTRUCTOR
10067Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
10068@item HAS_CONTENTS
10069Section is not empty.
10070@item NEVER_LOAD
10071An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
10072@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
10073A notification to the linker that the section contains
10074COFF shared library information.
10075@item IS_COMMON
10076Section contains common symbols.
10077@end table
10078@end table
6763aef9
MS
10079@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
10080@item set trust-readonly-sections on
10081Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 10082really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
10083In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
10084out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
10085For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
10086enhancement to debugging performance.
10087
10088The default is off.
10089
10090@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 10091Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
10092the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
10093and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
10094@end table
10095
10096All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
10097as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
10098name and remembers it that way.
10099
c906108c 10100@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
10101@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
10102libraries.
53a5351d 10103
c906108c
SS
10104@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
10105when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
10106(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
10107references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
10108debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
10109
10110On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
10111automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
10112
c906108c
SS
10113@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
10114@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
10115@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
10116
b7209cb4
FF
10117There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
10118symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
10119particularly large or there are many of them.
10120
10121To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
10122commands:
10123
10124@table @code
10125@kindex set auto-solib-add
10126@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
10127If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
10128will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
10129attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
10130informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
10131is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10132@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
10133
10134@kindex show auto-solib-add
10135@item show auto-solib-add
10136Display the current autoloading mode.
10137@end table
10138
10139To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
10140command:
10141
c906108c
SS
10142@table @code
10143@kindex info sharedlibrary
10144@kindex info share
10145@item info share
10146@itemx info sharedlibrary
10147Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
10148
10149@kindex sharedlibrary
10150@kindex share
10151@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
10152@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
10153Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
10154Unix regular expression.
10155As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
10156required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
10157@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
10158loaded.
10159@end table
10160
b7209cb4
FF
10161On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
10162autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
10163reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
10164by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
10165up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
10166wish.
c906108c
SS
10167
10168Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
10169loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
10170@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
10171automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
10172
10173To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
10174
10175@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
10176@kindex set auto-solib-limit
10177@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
10178Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
10179If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
10180symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
10181size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 10182Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 10183@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 10184Mb).
c906108c 10185
b7209cb4
FF
10186@kindex show auto-solib-limit
10187@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
10188Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
10189@end table
c906108c 10190
f5ebfba0
DJ
10191Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
10192configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
10193host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
10194copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
10195not.
10196
10197You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
10198load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
10199@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
10200libraries.
10201
10202@table @code
10203@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
10204@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
10205If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
10206absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
10207paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
10208@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
10209out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
10210@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
10211
10212You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
10213configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
10214
10215@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
10216@item show solib-absolute-prefix
10217Display the current shared library prefix.
10218
10219@kindex set solib-search-path
10220@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
10221If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
10222to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
10223@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
10224the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
10225@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
10226set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
10227@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
10228
10229@kindex show solib-search-path
10230@item show solib-search-path
10231Display the current shared library search path.
10232@end table
10233
5b5d99cf
JB
10234
10235@node Separate Debug Files
10236@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
10237@cindex separate debugging information files
10238@cindex debugging information in separate files
10239@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
10240@cindex debugging information directory, global
10241@cindex global debugging information directory
10242
10243@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
10244file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
10245@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
10246Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
10247than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
10248information for their executables in separate files, which users can
10249install only when they need to debug a problem.
10250
10251If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
10252separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
10253the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
10254components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
10255debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
10256containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
10257debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
10258will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
10259places:
10260
10261@itemize @bullet
10262@item
10263the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
10264for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
10265@item
10266a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
10267file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
10268@item
10269a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
10270executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
10271@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
10272@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
10273@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
10274@end itemize
10275@noindent
10276@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
10277information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
10278reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
10279
10280So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
10281which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
10282debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
10283for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
10284@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
10285@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
10286
10287You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
10288name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
10289
10290@table @code
10291
10292@kindex set debug-file-directory
10293@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
10294Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10295information files to @var{directory}.
10296
10297@kindex show debug-file-directory
10298@item show debug-file-directory
10299Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10300information files.
10301
10302@end table
10303
10304@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
10305@cindex debug links
10306A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
10307@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
10308
10309@itemize
10310@item
10311A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
10312a zero byte,
10313@item
10314zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
10315boundary within the section, and
10316@item
10317a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
10318executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
10319information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
10320zero as the @var{crc} argument.
10321@end itemize
10322
10323Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
10324contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
10325described above.
10326
10327The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
10328executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
10329debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
10330should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
10331but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
10332in an ordinary executable.
10333
10334As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
10335separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
10336Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
10337contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
10338@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
10339the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
10340@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
10341
10342Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
10343polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
10344describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
10345complete code for a function that computes it:
10346
10347@kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
10348@smallexample
10349unsigned long
10350gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
10351 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
10352@{
10353 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
10354 @{
10355 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
10356 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
10357 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
10358 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
10359 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
10360 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
10361 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
10362 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
10363 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
10364 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
10365 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
10366 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
10367 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
10368 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
10369 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
10370 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
10371 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
10372 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
10373 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
10374 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
10375 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
10376 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
10377 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
10378 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
10379 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
10380 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
10381 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
10382 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
10383 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
10384 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
10385 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
10386 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
10387 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
10388 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
10389 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10390 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10391 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10392 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10393 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10394 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10395 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10396 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10397 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10398 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10399 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10400 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10401 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10402 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10403 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10404 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10405 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10406 0x2d02ef8d
10407 @};
10408 unsigned char *end;
10409
10410 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10411 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10412 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
e7a3abfc 10413 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
5b5d99cf
JB
10414@}
10415@end smallexample
10416
10417
6d2ebf8b 10418@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
10419@section Errors reading symbol files
10420
10421While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10422such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10423output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10424they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10425debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10426about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10427only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10428times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10429to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10430complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10431messages}).
10432
10433The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10434
10435@table @code
10436@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10437
10438The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10439(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10440error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10441in its outer scope blocks.
10442
10443@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10444the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10445may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10446function.
10447
10448@item block at @var{address} out of order
10449
10450The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10451order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10452do so.
10453
10454@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10455locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10456can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10457@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10458messages}.)
10459
10460@item bad block start address patched
10461
10462The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10463smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10464to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10465
10466@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10467starting on the previous source line.
10468
10469@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10470
10471@cindex foo
10472Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10473larger than the size of the string table.
10474
10475@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10476name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10477with this name.
10478
10479@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10480
7a292a7a
SS
10481The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10482not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10483uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10484
7a292a7a
SS
10485@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10486This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10487are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10488debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10489on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10490and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10491
10492@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10493
7a292a7a 10494@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10495
7a292a7a 10496@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10497The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10498information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10499it.
c906108c
SS
10500
10501@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10502
10503@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10504
c906108c
SS
10505@end table
10506
6d2ebf8b 10507@node Targets
c906108c 10508@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10509
c906108c
SS
10510@cindex debugging target
10511@kindex target
10512
10513A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10514
10515Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10516in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10517you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10518flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10519host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10520realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10521command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10522(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10523
10524@menu
10525* Active Targets:: Active targets
10526* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10527* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10528* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10529* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10530
10531@end menu
10532
6d2ebf8b 10533@node Active Targets
c906108c 10534@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10535
c906108c
SS
10536@cindex stacking targets
10537@cindex active targets
10538@cindex multiple targets
10539
c906108c 10540There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10541executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10542active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10543start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10544a core file.
c906108c
SS
10545
10546For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10547@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10548well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10549@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10550first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10551requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10552are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10553read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10554executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10555
10556When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10557target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10558commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10559an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10560process target is active.
c906108c 10561
7a292a7a
SS
10562Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10563core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10564files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10565the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10566process}).
c906108c 10567
6d2ebf8b 10568@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10569@section Commands for managing targets
10570
10571@table @code
10572@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10573Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10574process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10575facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10576protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10577
10578Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10579typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10580with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10581
10582The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10583after executing the command.
10584
10585@kindex help target
10586@item help target
10587Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10588currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10589(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10590
10591@item help target @var{name}
10592Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10593select it.
10594
10595@kindex set gnutarget
10596@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10597@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10598knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10599a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10600with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10601with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10602
d4f3574e 10603@quotation
c906108c
SS
10604@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10605you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10606@end quotation
c906108c 10607
d4f3574e
SS
10608@noindent
10609@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10610
5d161b24 10611@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10612@item show gnutarget
10613Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10614@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10615@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10616and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10617@end table
10618
c906108c
SS
10619Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10620configuration):
c906108c
SS
10621
10622@table @code
10623@kindex target exec
10624@item target exec @var{program}
10625An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10626@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10627
c906108c
SS
10628@kindex target core
10629@item target core @var{filename}
10630A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10631@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10632
10633@kindex target remote
10634@item target remote @var{dev}
10635Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10636specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10637@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10638supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10639some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10640it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10641
c906108c
SS
10642@kindex target sim
10643@item target sim
2df3850c 10644Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10645In general,
474c8240 10646@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10647 target sim
10648 load
10649 run
474c8240 10650@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10651@noindent
104c1213 10652works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10653drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10654provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10655see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10656Processors}.
10657
c906108c
SS
10658@end table
10659
104c1213 10660Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10661
10662@table @code
10663
c906108c
SS
10664@kindex target nrom
10665@item target nrom @var{dev}
10666NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10667
c906108c
SS
10668@end table
10669
5d161b24 10670Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10671your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10672
10673Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10674once you've successfully established a connection.
10675
10676@table @code
10677
10678@kindex load @var{filename}
10679@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10680Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10681@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10682is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10683on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10684@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10685the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10686
10687If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10688execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10689target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10690
10691The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10692For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10693link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10694specifies a fixed address.
10695@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10696
c906108c
SS
10697@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10698@end table
10699
6d2ebf8b 10700@node Byte Order
c906108c 10701@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10702
c906108c
SS
10703@cindex choosing target byte order
10704@cindex target byte order
c906108c 10705
172c2a43 10706Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
c906108c
SS
10707offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10708orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10709designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10710which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10711@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10712
10713@table @code
10714@kindex set endian big
10715@item set endian big
10716Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10717
10718@kindex set endian little
10719@item set endian little
10720Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10721
10722@kindex set endian auto
10723@item set endian auto
10724Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10725executable.
10726
10727@item show endian
10728Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10729
10730@end table
10731
10732Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10733data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10734target system.
10735
6d2ebf8b 10736@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10737@section Remote debugging
10738@cindex remote debugging
10739
10740If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10741@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10742For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10743or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10744powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10745
10746Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10747to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10748@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10749but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10750write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10751communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10752
10753Other remote targets may be available in your
10754configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10755
6f05cf9f
AC
10756@node KOD
10757@section Kernel Object Display
6f05cf9f 10758@cindex kernel object display
6f05cf9f
AC
10759@cindex KOD
10760
10761Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10762@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10763and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10764mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10765displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10766
3bbe9696 10767@kindex set os
6f05cf9f
AC
10768Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10769@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10770
474c8240 10771@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10772(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10773@end smallexample
6f05cf9f 10774
3bbe9696
EZ
10775@kindex show os
10776The associated command @code{show os} displays the operating system
10777set with the @code{set os} command; if no operating system has been
10778set, @code{show os} will display an empty string @samp{""}.
10779
6f05cf9f
AC
10780If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10781about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10782which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10783after the operating system:
c906108c 10784
3bbe9696 10785@kindex info cisco
474c8240 10786@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10787(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10788List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10789Object Description
10790any Any and all objects
474c8240 10791@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10792
10793Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10794by the kernel.
10795
3bbe9696
EZ
10796There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating
10797system is supported other than to try setting it with @kbd{set os
10798@var{name}}, where @var{name} is the name of the operating system you
10799want to try.
6f05cf9f
AC
10800
10801
10802@node Remote Debugging
10803@chapter Debugging remote programs
10804
6b2f586d 10805@menu
07f31aa6 10806* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
6b2f586d
AC
10807* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10808* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
501eef12 10809* Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
6b2f586d 10810* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10811@end menu
10812
07f31aa6
DJ
10813@node Connecting
10814@section Connecting to a remote target
10815
10816On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
10817your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
10818Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
10819program as the first argument.
10820
10821@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10822If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
10823@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
10824before the @code{target} command.
10825
10826After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
10827the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
10828via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
10829(possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
10830target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
10831named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10832
10833@smallexample
10834target remote /dev/ttyb
10835@end smallexample
10836
10837@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10838To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10839@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10840For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10841terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10842
10843@smallexample
10844target remote manyfarms:2828
10845@end smallexample
10846
10847If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10848your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10849the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10850to port 1234 on your local machine:
10851
10852@smallexample
10853target remote :1234
10854@end smallexample
10855@noindent
10856
10857Note that the colon is still required here.
10858
10859@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10860To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10861@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10862on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10863
10864@smallexample
10865target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10866@end smallexample
10867
10868When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10869that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10870busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10871session.
10872
10873Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10874step and continue the remote program.
10875
10876@cindex interrupting remote programs
10877@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10878Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10879interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10880program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10881and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10882interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10883
10884@smallexample
10885Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10886Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10887@end smallexample
10888
10889If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10890(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10891remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10892goes back to waiting.
10893
10894@table @code
10895@kindex detach (remote)
10896@item detach
10897When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
10898@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
10899Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
10900will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
10901command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
10902
10903@kindex disconnect
10904@item disconnect
10905The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
10906the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
10907(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
10908the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
10909another target.
10910@end table
10911
6f05cf9f
AC
10912@node Server
10913@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10914
10915@kindex gdbserver
10916@cindex remote connection without stubs
10917@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10918allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10919@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10920
10921@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10922because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10923that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10924@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10925@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10926because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10927also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10928started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10929Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10930the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10931do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10932by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10933choice for debugging.
10934
10935@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10936or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10937protocol.
10938
10939@table @emph
10940@item On the target machine,
10941you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10942@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10943strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10944system does all the symbol handling.
10945
10946To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10947the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10948syntax is:
10949
10950@smallexample
10951target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10952@end smallexample
10953
10954@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10955hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10956@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10957@file{/dev/com1}:
10958
10959@smallexample
10960target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10961@end smallexample
10962
10963@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10964with it.
10965
10966To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10967
10968@smallexample
10969target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10970@end smallexample
10971
10972The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10973specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10974TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10975expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10976(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10977you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10978TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10979reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10980conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10981and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10982@code{target remote} command.
10983
56460a61
DJ
10984On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10985This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10986
10987@smallexample
10988target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10989@end smallexample
10990
10991@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10992to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10993
b1fe9455
DJ
10994@pindex pidof
10995@cindex attach to a program by name
10996You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
10997@code{pidof} utility:
10998
10999@smallexample
11000target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
11001@end smallexample
11002
11003In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
11004has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
11005@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
11006
07f31aa6
DJ
11007@item On the host machine,
11008connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
6f05cf9f
AC
11009For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
11010the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
11011text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
07f31aa6
DJ
11012@samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
11013command in @value{GDBN} when using gdbserver, since the program is
11014already on the target.
11015
6f05cf9f
AC
11016@end table
11017
11018@node NetWare
11019@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
11020
11021@kindex gdbserve.nlm
11022@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
11023allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
11024@code{target remote}.
11025
11026@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
11027using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
11028
11029@table @emph
11030@item On the target machine,
11031you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
11032@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
11033can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
11034host system does all the symbol handling.
11035
11036To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
11037@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
11038program. The syntax is:
11039
11040@smallexample
11041load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
11042 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
11043@end smallexample
11044
11045@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
11046the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
11047to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
11048
11049For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
11050communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
11051using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
11052
11053@smallexample
11054load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
11055@end smallexample
11056
07f31aa6
DJ
11057@item
11058On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
11059Connecting to a remote target}).
6f05cf9f 11060
6f05cf9f
AC
11061@end table
11062
501eef12
AC
11063@node Remote configuration
11064@section Remote configuration
11065
11066The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
11067programs:
11068
11069@table @code
11070@kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
11071@kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
11072@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
11073@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
11074@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
11075@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
11076Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
11077watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
11078@end table
11079
6f05cf9f
AC
11080@node remote stub
11081@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 11082
8e04817f
AC
11083@cindex debugging stub, example
11084@cindex remote stub, example
11085@cindex stub example, remote debugging
11086The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
11087communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
11088@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
11089these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
11090implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
11091with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
11092organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
11093
104c1213
JM
11094@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
11095To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
11096@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
11097prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
11098program, you need:
c906108c 11099
104c1213
JM
11100@enumerate
11101@item
11102A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
11103have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
11104your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 11105
5d161b24 11106@item
d4f3574e 11107A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 11108subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 11109
104c1213
JM
11110@item
11111A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
11112download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
11113manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
11114documentation.
11115@end enumerate
96baa820 11116
104c1213
JM
11117The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
11118communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
11119machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 11120
104c1213
JM
11121@table @emph
11122@item On the host,
11123@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
11124else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
11125(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
11126
11127@item On the target,
11128you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
11129implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
11130subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
11131
11132On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
11133@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
11134@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
11135@end table
96baa820 11136
104c1213
JM
11137The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
11138machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
11139@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 11140
104c1213
JM
11141@cindex remote serial stub list
11142These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 11143
104c1213
JM
11144@table @code
11145
11146@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 11147@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
11148@cindex Intel
11149@cindex i386
11150For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
11151
11152@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 11153@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
11154@cindex Motorola 680x0
11155@cindex m680x0
11156For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
11157
11158@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 11159@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
172c2a43 11160@cindex Renesas
104c1213 11161@cindex SH
172c2a43 11162For Renesas SH architectures.
104c1213
JM
11163
11164@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 11165@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
11166@cindex Sparc
11167For @sc{sparc} architectures.
11168
11169@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 11170@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
11171@cindex Fujitsu
11172@cindex SparcLite
11173For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
11174
11175@end table
11176
11177The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
11178recently added stubs.
11179
11180@menu
11181* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
11182* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
11183* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
11184@end menu
11185
6d2ebf8b 11186@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 11187@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
11188
11189@cindex remote serial stub
11190The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
11191subroutines:
11192
11193@table @code
11194@item set_debug_traps
11195@kindex set_debug_traps
11196@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
11197This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
11198program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
11199beginning of your program.
11200
11201@item handle_exception
11202@kindex handle_exception
11203@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
11204This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
11205explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
11206run when a trap is triggered.
11207
11208@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
11209execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
11210with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
11211protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 11212representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
11213information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
11214retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
11215execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
11216@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 11217machine.
104c1213
JM
11218
11219@item breakpoint
11220@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
11221Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
11222breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
11223way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
11224machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
11225pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
11226@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
11227simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
11228again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
11229your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 11230@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
11231
11232Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
11233to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
11234start of your debugging session.
11235@end table
11236
6d2ebf8b 11237@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 11238@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
11239
11240@cindex remote stub, support routines
11241The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
11242chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
11243debugging target machine.
11244
11245First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
11246serial port.
11247
11248@table @code
11249@item int getDebugChar()
11250@kindex getDebugChar
11251Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
11252It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
11253different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11254
11255@item void putDebugChar(int)
11256@kindex putDebugChar
11257Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 11258It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
11259different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11260@end table
11261
11262@cindex control C, and remote debugging
11263@cindex interrupting remote targets
11264If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
11265running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
11266for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
11267character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
11268remote system to stop.
11269
11270Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
11271probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
11272is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
11273@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
11274
11275Other routines you need to supply are:
11276
11277@table @code
11278@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
11279@kindex exceptionHandler
11280Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
11281handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
11282way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
11283are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
11284containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
11285@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
11286its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
11287might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
11288exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
11289@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
11290and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
11291you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
11292should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
11293
11294For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
11295gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
11296should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
11297@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
11298help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
11299
11300@item void flush_i_cache()
11301@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 11302On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
11303instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
11304instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
11305
11306On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
11307function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
11308@end table
11309
11310@noindent
11311You must also make sure this library routine is available:
11312
11313@table @code
11314@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
11315@kindex memset
11316This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11317memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11318@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11319either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11320@end table
11321
11322If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11323library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11324but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 11325subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
11326
11327
6d2ebf8b 11328@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 11329@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
11330
11331@cindex remote serial debugging summary
11332In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11333steps.
11334
11335@enumerate
11336@item
6d2ebf8b 11337Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
11338(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11339@display
11340@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11341@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11342@end display
11343
11344@item
11345Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11346
474c8240 11347@smallexample
104c1213
JM
11348set_debug_traps();
11349breakpoint();
474c8240 11350@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11351
11352@item
11353For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11354@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11355
474c8240 11356@smallexample
104c1213 11357void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 11358@end smallexample
104c1213 11359
d4f3574e 11360@noindent
104c1213 11361but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 11362function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
11363@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11364error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11365one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11366
11367@item
11368Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11369your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11370
11371@item
11372Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11373the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11374
11375@item
11376@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11377@c document that. FIXME.
11378Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11379whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11380
11381@item
07f31aa6
DJ
11382Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
11383(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
9db8d71f 11384
104c1213
JM
11385@end enumerate
11386
8e04817f
AC
11387@node Configurations
11388@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 11389
8e04817f
AC
11390While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11391cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11392describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 11393
8e04817f
AC
11394There are three major categories of configurations: native
11395configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11396operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11397different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11398are quite different from each other.
104c1213 11399
8e04817f
AC
11400@menu
11401* Native::
11402* Embedded OS::
11403* Embedded Processors::
11404* Architectures::
11405@end menu
104c1213 11406
8e04817f
AC
11407@node Native
11408@section Native
104c1213 11409
8e04817f
AC
11410This section describes details specific to particular native
11411configurations.
6cf7e474 11412
8e04817f
AC
11413@menu
11414* HP-UX:: HP-UX
11415* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11416* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 11417* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 11418@end menu
6cf7e474 11419
8e04817f
AC
11420@node HP-UX
11421@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 11422
8e04817f
AC
11423On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11424begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11425name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 11426
8e04817f
AC
11427@node SVR4 Process Information
11428@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 11429
8e04817f
AC
11430@kindex /proc
11431@cindex process image
104c1213 11432
8e04817f
AC
11433Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11434used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11435subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11436this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11437several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11438@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11439@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 11440and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 11441
8e04817f
AC
11442@table @code
11443@kindex info proc
11444@item info proc
11445Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 11446
8e04817f
AC
11447@kindex info proc mappings
11448@item info proc mappings
11449Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11450on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11451@ignore
11452@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11453@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11454@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11455@kindex info proc times
11456@item info proc times
11457Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11458its children.
6cf7e474 11459
8e04817f
AC
11460@kindex info proc id
11461@item info proc id
11462Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11463the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 11464
8e04817f
AC
11465@kindex info proc status
11466@item info proc status
11467General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11468stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11469received.
d4f3574e 11470
8e04817f
AC
11471@item info proc all
11472Show all the above information about the process.
11473@end ignore
11474@end table
104c1213 11475
8e04817f
AC
11476@node DJGPP Native
11477@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11478@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11479@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11480@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11481
8e04817f
AC
11482@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11483MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11484that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11485top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11486
8e04817f
AC
11487@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11488defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11489subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11490
8e04817f
AC
11491@table @code
11492@kindex info dos
11493@item info dos
11494This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11495information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11496
8e04817f
AC
11497@kindex sysinfo
11498@cindex MS-DOS system info
11499@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11500@item info dos sysinfo
11501This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11502platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11503DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11504
8e04817f
AC
11505@cindex GDT
11506@cindex LDT
11507@cindex IDT
11508@cindex segment descriptor tables
11509@cindex descriptor tables display
11510@item info dos gdt
11511@itemx info dos ldt
11512@itemx info dos idt
11513These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11514and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11515tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11516that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11517descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11518descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11519rights.
104c1213 11520
8e04817f
AC
11521A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11522segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11523allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11524conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11525additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11526
8e04817f
AC
11527@cindex garbled pointers
11528These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11529Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11530displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11531display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11532example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11533debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11534
8e04817f
AC
11535@smallexample
11536@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11537@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11538@end smallexample
104c1213 11539
8e04817f
AC
11540@noindent
11541This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11542the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11543
8e04817f
AC
11544@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11545@item info dos pde
11546@itemx info dos pte
11547These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11548Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11549data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11550into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11551page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11552may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11553Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11554that is currently in use.
104c1213 11555
8e04817f
AC
11556Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11557Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11558the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11559@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11560Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11561means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11562the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11563
8e04817f
AC
11564@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11565These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11566Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11567controller.
104c1213 11568
8e04817f 11569These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11570
8e04817f
AC
11571@cindex physical address from linear address
11572@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11573This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11574address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11575appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11576accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11577example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11578the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11579
b383017d 11580@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11581@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11582@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
b383017d 11583@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
8e04817f 11584@end smallexample
104c1213 11585
8e04817f
AC
11586@noindent
11587This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11588whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11589attributes of that page.
104c1213 11590
8e04817f
AC
11591Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11592since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11593address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11594be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11595declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11596@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11597
8e04817f
AC
11598Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11599transfer buffer:
104c1213 11600
8e04817f
AC
11601@smallexample
11602@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11603@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11604@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11605@end smallexample
104c1213 11606
8e04817f
AC
11607@noindent
11608(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
116093rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11610this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11611mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11612
8e04817f
AC
11613This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11614@end table
104c1213 11615
78c47bea
PM
11616@node Cygwin Native
11617@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11618@cindex MS Windows debugging
11619@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11620@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11621
be448670
CF
11622@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11623DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11624additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11625subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11626that have no debugging symbols.
11627
78c47bea
PM
11628
11629@table @code
11630@kindex info w32
11631@item info w32
11632This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11633information about the target system and important OS structures.
11634
11635@item info w32 selector
11636This command displays information returned by
11637the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11638It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11639a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11640Without argument, this command displays information
11641about the the six segment registers.
11642
11643@kindex info dll
11644@item info dll
11645This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11646
11647@kindex dll-symbols
11648@item dll-symbols
11649This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11650add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11651
b383017d 11652@kindex set new-console
78c47bea 11653@item set new-console @var{mode}
b383017d 11654If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
78c47bea
PM
11655be started in a new console on next start.
11656If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11657be started in the same console as the debugger.
11658
11659@kindex show new-console
11660@item show new-console
11661Displays whether a new console is used
11662when the debuggee is started.
11663
11664@kindex set new-group
11665@item set new-group @var{mode}
11666This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11667start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11668This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11669Ctrl-C.
11670
11671@kindex show new-group
11672@item show new-group
11673Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11674
11675@kindex set debugevents
11676@item set debugevents
11677This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11678
11679@kindex set debugexec
11680@item set debugexec
b383017d 11681This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
78c47bea
PM
11682seen by the debugger.
11683
11684@kindex set debugexceptions
11685@item set debugexceptions
b383017d 11686This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
78c47bea
PM
11687seen by the debugger.
11688
11689@kindex set debugmemory
11690@item set debugmemory
b383017d 11691This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
78c47bea
PM
11692seen by the debugger.
11693
11694@kindex set shell
11695@item set shell
11696This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11697via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11698
11699@kindex show shell
11700@item show shell
11701Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11702
11703@end table
11704
be448670
CF
11705@menu
11706* Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11707@end menu
11708
11709@node Non-debug DLL symbols
11710@subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11711@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11712@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11713
11714Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11715not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11716@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11717symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11718information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11719describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11720``minimal symbols''.
11721
11722Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11723will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11724start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11725program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11726@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11727see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11728@code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11729explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11730cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11731which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11732
11733@subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11734
11735In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11736tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11737DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11738also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11739sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11740(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11741necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11742contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11743exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11744
11745Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11746though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11747symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11748some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11749@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11750@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11751
11752@smallexample
11753(gdb) info function CreateFileA
11754All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11755
11756Non-debugging symbols:
117570x77e885f4 CreateFileA
117580x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11759@end smallexample
11760
11761@smallexample
11762(gdb) info function !
11763All functions matching regular expression "!":
11764
11765Non-debugging symbols:
117660x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
117670x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
117680x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11769[etc...]
11770@end smallexample
11771
11772@subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11773
11774Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11775type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11776refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11777contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11778contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11779means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11780a function within a DLL without a running program.
11781
11782Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11783automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11784variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11785type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11786problem:
11787
11788@smallexample
11789(gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11790$1 = 268572168
11791@end smallexample
11792
11793@smallexample
11794(gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
117950x10021610: "\230y\""
11796@end smallexample
11797
11798And two possible solutions:
11799
11800@smallexample
11801(gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11802$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11803@end smallexample
11804
11805@smallexample
11806(gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
118070x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11808(gdb) x/x 0x10021608
118090x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11810(gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
118110x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11812@end smallexample
11813
11814Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11815starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11816examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11817function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11818to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11819
11820@smallexample
11821(gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11822Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11823@end smallexample
11824
11825The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11826break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11827safe.
11828
8e04817f
AC
11829@node Embedded OS
11830@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11831
8e04817f
AC
11832This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11833embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11834architectures.
d4f3574e 11835
8e04817f
AC
11836@menu
11837* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11838@end menu
104c1213 11839
8e04817f
AC
11840@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11841various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11842
8e04817f
AC
11843@node VxWorks
11844@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11845
8e04817f 11846@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11847
8e04817f 11848@table @code
104c1213 11849
8e04817f
AC
11850@kindex target vxworks
11851@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11852A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11853is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11854
8e04817f 11855@end table
104c1213 11856
8e04817f
AC
11857On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11858current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11859
8e04817f
AC
11860@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11861VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11862the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11863both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11864@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11865installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11866@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11867
8e04817f
AC
11868@table @code
11869@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11870@kindex vxworks-timeout
11871All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11872This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11873seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11874your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11875of a thin network line.
11876@end table
104c1213 11877
8e04817f
AC
11878The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11879this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11880procedures.
104c1213 11881
8e04817f
AC
11882@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11883To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11884to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11885library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11886VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11887kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11888source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11889information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11890manual.
11891@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11892
8e04817f
AC
11893Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11894your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11895run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11896@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11897
8e04817f 11898@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11899
474c8240 11900@smallexample
8e04817f 11901(vxgdb)
474c8240 11902@end smallexample
104c1213 11903
8e04817f
AC
11904@menu
11905* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11906* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11907* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11908@end menu
104c1213 11909
8e04817f
AC
11910@node VxWorks Connection
11911@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11912
8e04817f
AC
11913The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11914network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11915
474c8240 11916@smallexample
8e04817f 11917(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11918@end smallexample
104c1213 11919
8e04817f
AC
11920@need 750
11921@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11922
8e04817f
AC
11923@smallexample
11924Attaching remote machine across net...
11925Connected to tt.
11926@end smallexample
104c1213 11927
8e04817f
AC
11928@need 1000
11929@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11930loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11931these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11932path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11933to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11934
474c8240 11935@smallexample
8e04817f 11936prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11937@end smallexample
104c1213 11938
8e04817f
AC
11939When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11940the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11941command again.
104c1213 11942
8e04817f
AC
11943@node VxWorks Download
11944@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11945
8e04817f
AC
11946@cindex download to VxWorks
11947If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11948object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11949@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11950incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11951command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11952to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11953table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11954the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11955filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11956Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11957to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11958the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11959@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11960and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11961program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11962
474c8240 11963@smallexample
8e04817f 11964-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11965@end smallexample
104c1213 11966
8e04817f
AC
11967@noindent
11968Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11969
474c8240 11970@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11971(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11972(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11973@end smallexample
104c1213 11974
8e04817f 11975@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11976
8e04817f
AC
11977@smallexample
11978Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11979@end smallexample
104c1213 11980
8e04817f
AC
11981You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11982after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11983this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11984auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11985history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11986debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11987table.)
104c1213 11988
8e04817f
AC
11989@node VxWorks Attach
11990@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11991
11992@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11993You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11994follows:
11995
474c8240 11996@smallexample
104c1213 11997(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11998@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11999
12000@noindent
12001where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
12002or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
12003the time of attachment.
12004
6d2ebf8b 12005@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
12006@section Embedded Processors
12007
12008This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
12009configurations.
12010
7d86b5d5 12011
104c1213 12012@menu
104c1213 12013* ARM:: ARM
172c2a43
KI
12014* H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
12015* H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
12016* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
104c1213 12017* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 12018* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 12019* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
12020* PA:: HP PA Embedded
12021* PowerPC: PowerPC
172c2a43 12022* SH:: Renesas SH
104c1213
JM
12023* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
12024* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
12025* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
12026* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
12027@end menu
12028
6d2ebf8b 12029@node ARM
104c1213
JM
12030@subsection ARM
12031
12032@table @code
12033
8e04817f
AC
12034@kindex target rdi
12035@item target rdi @var{dev}
12036ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
12037use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
12038monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
12039
12040@kindex target rdp
12041@item target rdp @var{dev}
12042ARM Demon monitor.
12043
12044@end table
12045
12046@node H8/300
172c2a43 12047@subsection Renesas H8/300
8e04817f
AC
12048
12049@table @code
12050
12051@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
12052@item target hms @var{dev}
172c2a43 12053A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
8e04817f
AC
12054Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
12055line and the communications speed used.
12056
12057@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
12058@item target e7000 @var{dev}
172c2a43 12059E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
8e04817f
AC
12060
12061@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
12062@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
12063@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12064@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
172c2a43 12065Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
8e04817f
AC
12066
12067@end table
12068
12069@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
12070@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
172c2a43
KI
12071@cindex download to Renesas SH
12072@cindex Renesas SH download
12073When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
12074board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
8e04817f
AC
12075board and also opens it as the current executable target for
12076@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
12077
12078@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
172c2a43 12079Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
8e04817f
AC
12080
12081@enumerate
12082@item
12083that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
172c2a43
KI
12084for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
12085emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
12086the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
8e04817f
AC
12087H8/300, or H8/500.)
12088
12089@item
172c2a43 12090what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
8e04817f
AC
12091serial device available on your host is the default).
12092
12093@item
12094what speed to use over the serial device.
12095@end enumerate
12096
12097@menu
172c2a43
KI
12098* Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
12099* Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
12100* Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
8e04817f
AC
12101@end menu
12102
172c2a43
KI
12103@node Renesas Boards
12104@subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
8e04817f
AC
12105
12106@c only for Unix hosts
12107@kindex device
172c2a43 12108@cindex serial device, Renesas micros
8e04817f
AC
12109Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
12110need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
12111first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
12112hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
12113
12114@kindex speed
172c2a43 12115@cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
8e04817f
AC
12116@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
12117speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
12118hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
12119the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
12120@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
12121
12122The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
172c2a43 12123use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
8e04817f
AC
12124use a DOS host,
12125@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
12126called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
12127through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
12128to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
12129
12130The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
12131program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
12132sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
172c2a43 12133the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
8e04817f
AC
12134
12135First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
12136board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
12137port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
12138When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
12139debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
12140for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
12141@code{COM2}.
12142
474c8240 12143@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12144C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
12145C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
12146
12147Resident portion of MODE loaded
12148
12149COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
12150
474c8240 12151@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12152
12153@quotation
12154@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
12155@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
12156disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
12157your development board.
12158@end quotation
12159
12160@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
12161Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
12162connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
12163the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
12164you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
12165commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
172c2a43 12166cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
8e04817f
AC
12167download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
12168the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
12169(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
12170executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
12171@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
12172itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
12173
12174@smallexample
12175(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
12176@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
12177 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
12178 the conditions.
12179There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
12180for details.
12181@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
12182(@value{GDBP}) target hms
12183Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
12184(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
12185.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
12186.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
12187.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
12188@end smallexample
12189
12190At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
12191you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
12192sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
12193@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
12194resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
12195@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
12196
12197Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
12198available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
12199you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
12200
12201Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
12202@itemize @bullet
12203@item
12204to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
12205no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
12206
12207@item
12208to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
12209normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
12210to detect program completion.
12211@end itemize
12212
12213In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
12214development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
12215
172c2a43 12216@node Renesas ICE
8e04817f
AC
12217@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
12218
172c2a43 12219@kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
8e04817f 12220You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
172c2a43 12221Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
8e04817f
AC
12222e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
12223
12224@table @code
12225@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
12226Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
12227@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
12228@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
12229(for example, @samp{9600}).
12230
12231@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
12232If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
12233specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
12234@end table
12235
172c2a43
KI
12236@node Renesas Special
12237@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
8e04817f
AC
12238
12239Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
12240
12241@table @code
12242
12243@kindex set machine
12244@kindex show machine
12245@item set machine h8300
12246@itemx set machine h8300h
12247Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
12248architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
12249to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
12250
12251@end table
12252
8e04817f
AC
12253@node H8/500
12254@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
12255
12256@table @code
12257
8e04817f
AC
12258@kindex set memory @var{mod}
12259@cindex memory models, H8/500
12260@item set memory @var{mod}
12261@itemx show memory
12262Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12263@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12264memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12265@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 12266
8e04817f 12267@end table
104c1213 12268
8e04817f 12269@node M32R/D
172c2a43 12270@subsection Renesas M32R/D
8e04817f
AC
12271
12272@table @code
12273
12274@kindex target m32r
12275@item target m32r @var{dev}
172c2a43 12276Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
8e04817f 12277
fb3e19c0
KI
12278@kindex target m32rsdi
12279@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
12280Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
12281
8e04817f
AC
12282@end table
12283
12284@node M68K
12285@subsection M68k
12286
12287The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12288target command for the following ROM monitors.
12289
12290@table @code
12291
12292@kindex target abug
12293@item target abug @var{dev}
12294ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12295
12296@kindex target cpu32bug
12297@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12298CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12299
12300@kindex target dbug
12301@item target dbug @var{dev}
12302dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12303
12304@kindex target est
12305@item target est @var{dev}
12306EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12307
12308@kindex target rom68k
12309@item target rom68k @var{dev}
12310ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12311
12312@end table
12313
8e04817f
AC
12314@table @code
12315
12316@kindex target rombug
12317@item target rombug @var{dev}
12318ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12319
12320@end table
12321
8e04817f
AC
12322@node MIPS Embedded
12323@subsection MIPS Embedded
12324
12325@cindex MIPS boards
12326@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12327MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12328you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 12329
8e04817f
AC
12330@need 1000
12331Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 12332
8e04817f
AC
12333@table @code
12334@item target mips @var{port}
12335@kindex target mips @var{port}
12336To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12337name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12338command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12339the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12340been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12341download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 12342
8e04817f
AC
12343For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12344port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12345debugger:
104c1213 12346
474c8240 12347@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12348host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12349@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12350(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12351(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12352(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 12353@end smallexample
104c1213 12354
8e04817f
AC
12355@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12356On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12357connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12358concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12359@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12360
8e04817f
AC
12361@item target pmon @var{port}
12362@kindex target pmon @var{port}
12363PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 12364
8e04817f
AC
12365@item target ddb @var{port}
12366@kindex target ddb @var{port}
12367NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 12368
8e04817f
AC
12369@item target lsi @var{port}
12370@kindex target lsi @var{port}
12371LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@kindex target r3900
12374@item target r3900 @var{dev}
12375Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 12376
8e04817f
AC
12377@kindex target array
12378@item target array @var{dev}
12379Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 12380
8e04817f 12381@end table
104c1213 12382
104c1213 12383
8e04817f
AC
12384@noindent
12385@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 12386
8e04817f
AC
12387@table @code
12388@item set processor @var{args}
12389@itemx show processor
12390@kindex set processor @var{args}
12391@kindex show processor
12392Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12393processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12394For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12395to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12396Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12397is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12398@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 12399
8e04817f
AC
12400@item set mipsfpu double
12401@itemx set mipsfpu single
12402@itemx set mipsfpu none
12403@itemx show mipsfpu
12404@kindex set mipsfpu
12405@kindex show mipsfpu
12406@cindex MIPS remote floating point
12407@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12408If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12409coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12410need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12411file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12412functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12413@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12414functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12415with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12416processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12417double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12418@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 12419
8e04817f
AC
12420In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12421floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12422and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 12423
8e04817f
AC
12424As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12425@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 12426
8e04817f
AC
12427@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12428@itemx show remotedebug
12429@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12430@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12431@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12432@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12433@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12434@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12435You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12436by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12437@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12438to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12439at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 12440
8e04817f
AC
12441@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12442@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12443@itemx show timeout
12444@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12445@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12446@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12447@kindex set timeout
12448@kindex show timeout
12449@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12450@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12451You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12452remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12453default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12454waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12455retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12456You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12457retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12458@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 12459
8e04817f
AC
12460The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12461is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12462forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12463to run before stopping.
12464@end table
104c1213 12465
a37295f9
MM
12466@node OpenRISC 1000
12467@subsection OpenRISC 1000
12468@cindex OpenRISC 1000
12469
12470@cindex or1k boards
12471See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12472about platform and commands.
12473
12474@table @code
12475
12476@kindex target jtag
12477@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12478
12479Connects to remote JTAG server.
12480JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12481connected via parallel port to the board.
12482
12483Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12484
12485@kindex or1ksim
12486@item or1ksim @var{command}
12487If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12488Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12489
12490@kindex info or1k spr
12491@item info or1k spr
12492Displays spr groups.
12493
12494@item info or1k spr @var{group}
12495@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12496Displays register names in selected group.
12497
12498@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12499@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12500@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12501@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12502Shows information about specified spr register.
12503
12504@kindex spr
12505@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12506@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12507@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12508@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12509Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12510@end table
12511
12512Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12513It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12514program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12515triggers can be set using:
12516@table @code
12517@item $LEA/$LDATA
12518Load effective address/data
12519@item $SEA/$SDATA
12520Store effective address/data
12521@item $AEA/$ADATA
12522Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12523@item $FETCH
12524Fetch data
12525@end table
12526
12527When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12528@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12529
12530@code{htrace} commands:
12531@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12532@table @code
12533@kindex hwatch
12534@item hwatch @var{conditional}
12535Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12536or Data. For example:
12537
12538@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12539
12540@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12541
12542@kindex htrace info
12543@item htrace info
12544Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12545
12546@kindex htrace trigger
12547@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12548Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12549
12550@kindex htrace qualifier
12551@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12552Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12553
12554@kindex htrace stop
12555@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12556Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12557
12558@kindex htrace record
f153cc92 12559@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
a37295f9
MM
12560Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12561triggered.
12562
12563@kindex htrace enable
12564@item htrace enable
12565@kindex htrace disable
12566@itemx htrace disable
12567Enables/disables the HW trace.
12568
12569@kindex htrace rewind
f153cc92 12570@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
a37295f9
MM
12571Clears currently recorded trace data.
12572
12573If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12574will be written there.
12575
12576@kindex htrace print
f153cc92 12577@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
a37295f9
MM
12578Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12579
12580@kindex htrace mode continuous
12581@item htrace mode continuous
12582Set continuous trace mode.
12583
12584@kindex htrace mode suspend
12585@item htrace mode suspend
12586Set suspend trace mode.
12587
12588@end table
12589
8e04817f
AC
12590@node PowerPC
12591@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12592
12593@table @code
104c1213 12594
8e04817f
AC
12595@kindex target dink32
12596@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12597DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 12598
8e04817f
AC
12599@kindex target ppcbug
12600@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12601@kindex target ppcbug1
12602@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12603PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 12604
8e04817f
AC
12605@kindex target sds
12606@item target sds @var{dev}
12607SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12608
12609@end table
12610
12611@node PA
12612@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12613
12614@table @code
12615
8e04817f
AC
12616@kindex target op50n
12617@item target op50n @var{dev}
12618OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12619
12620@kindex target w89k
12621@item target w89k @var{dev}
12622W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12623
12624@end table
12625
8e04817f 12626@node SH
172c2a43 12627@subsection Renesas SH
104c1213
JM
12628
12629@table @code
12630
172c2a43 12631@kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
8e04817f 12632@item target hms @var{dev}
172c2a43 12633A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
8e04817f
AC
12634commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12635the communications speed used.
104c1213 12636
172c2a43 12637@kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
8e04817f 12638@item target e7000 @var{dev}
172c2a43 12639E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
104c1213 12640
8e04817f
AC
12641@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12642@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12643@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12644@item target sh3e @var{dev}
172c2a43 12645Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12646
8e04817f 12647@end table
104c1213 12648
8e04817f
AC
12649@node Sparclet
12650@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12651
8e04817f
AC
12652@cindex Sparclet
12653
12654@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12655Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12656@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12657both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12658@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12659
8e04817f
AC
12660@table @code
12661@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12662@kindex remotetimeout
12663@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12664This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12665seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12666@end table
12667
8e04817f
AC
12668@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12669When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12670information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12671load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12672@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12673
474c8240 12674@smallexample
8e04817f 12675sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12676@end smallexample
104c1213 12677
8e04817f 12678You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12679
474c8240 12680@smallexample
8e04817f 12681sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12682@end smallexample
104c1213 12683
8e04817f
AC
12684@cindex running, on Sparclet
12685Once you have set
12686your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12687run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12688(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12689
8e04817f
AC
12690@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12691
474c8240 12692@smallexample
8e04817f 12693(gdbslet)
474c8240 12694@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12695
12696@menu
8e04817f
AC
12697* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12698* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12699* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12700* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12701@end menu
12702
8e04817f
AC
12703@node Sparclet File
12704@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12705
8e04817f 12706The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12707
474c8240 12708@smallexample
8e04817f 12709(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12710@end smallexample
104c1213 12711
8e04817f
AC
12712@need 1000
12713@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12714@value{GDBN} locates
12715the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12716path.
12717If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12718files will be searched as well.
12719@value{GDBN} locates
12720the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12721path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12722If it fails
12723to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12724
474c8240 12725@smallexample
8e04817f 12726prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12727@end smallexample
104c1213 12728
8e04817f
AC
12729When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12730the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12731@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12732
8e04817f
AC
12733@node Sparclet Connection
12734@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12735
8e04817f
AC
12736The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12737To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12738
474c8240 12739@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12740(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12741Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12742main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12743@end smallexample
104c1213 12744
8e04817f
AC
12745@need 750
12746@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12747
474c8240 12748@smallexample
8e04817f 12749Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12750@end smallexample
104c1213 12751
8e04817f
AC
12752@node Sparclet Download
12753@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12754
8e04817f
AC
12755@cindex download to Sparclet
12756Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12757you can use the @value{GDBN}
12758@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12759The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12760command.
12761Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12762address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12763offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12764of each of the file's sections.
12765For instance, if the program
12766@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12767and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12768
474c8240 12769@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12770(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12771Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12772@end smallexample
104c1213 12773
8e04817f
AC
12774If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12775to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12776to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12777
12778@node Sparclet Execution
12779@subsubsection Running and debugging
12780
12781@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12782You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12783commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12784manual for the list of commands.
12785
474c8240 12786@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12787(gdbslet) b main
12788Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12789(gdbslet) run
12790Starting program: prog
12791Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
127923 char *symarg = 0;
12793(gdbslet) step
127944 char *execarg = "hello!";
12795(gdbslet)
474c8240 12796@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12797
12798@node Sparclite
12799@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12800
12801@table @code
12802
8e04817f
AC
12803@kindex target sparclite
12804@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12805Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12806You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12807For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12808remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12809
12810@end table
12811
8e04817f
AC
12812@node ST2000
12813@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12814
8e04817f
AC
12815@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12816STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12817
8e04817f
AC
12818To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12819manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12820
474c8240 12821@smallexample
8e04817f 12822target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12823@end smallexample
104c1213 12824
8e04817f
AC
12825@noindent
12826to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12827the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12828ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12829connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12830concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12831
8e04817f
AC
12832The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12833this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12834would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12835(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12836available on your host computer.
12837@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12838@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12839
8e04817f
AC
12840@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12841These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12842environment:
104c1213 12843
8e04817f
AC
12844@table @code
12845@item st2000 @var{command}
12846@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12847@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12848@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12849Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12850manual for available commands.
104c1213 12851
8e04817f
AC
12852@item connect
12853@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12854Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12855you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12856sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12857@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12858@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12859@end table
12860
8e04817f
AC
12861@node Z8000
12862@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12863
8e04817f
AC
12864@cindex Z8000
12865@cindex simulator, Z8000
12866@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12867
8e04817f
AC
12868When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12869a Z8000 simulator.
12870
12871For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12872unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12873segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12874appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12875
8e04817f
AC
12876@table @code
12877@item target sim @var{args}
12878@kindex sim
12879@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12880Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12881options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12882@end table
12883
8e04817f
AC
12884@noindent
12885After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12886CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12887@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12888to run your program, and so on.
12889
12890As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12891(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12892additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12893
12894@table @code
12895
8e04817f
AC
12896@item cycles
12897Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12898
8e04817f
AC
12899@item insts
12900Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12901
8e04817f
AC
12902@item time
12903Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12904
8e04817f 12905@end table
104c1213 12906
8e04817f
AC
12907You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12908conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12909conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12910simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12911
8e04817f
AC
12912@node Architectures
12913@section Architectures
104c1213 12914
8e04817f
AC
12915This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12916all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12917
8e04817f
AC
12918@menu
12919* A29K::
12920* Alpha::
12921* MIPS::
12922@end menu
104c1213 12923
8e04817f
AC
12924@node A29K
12925@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12926
12927@table @code
104c1213 12928
8e04817f
AC
12929@kindex set rstack_high_address
12930@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12931@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12932@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12933On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12934@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12935extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12936stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12937memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12938this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12939the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12940address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12941hexadecimal.
104c1213 12942
8e04817f
AC
12943@kindex show rstack_high_address
12944@item show rstack_high_address
12945Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12946processors.
104c1213 12947
8e04817f 12948@end table
104c1213 12949
8e04817f
AC
12950@node Alpha
12951@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12952
8e04817f 12953See the following section.
104c1213 12954
8e04817f
AC
12955@node MIPS
12956@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12957
8e04817f
AC
12958@cindex stack on Alpha
12959@cindex stack on MIPS
12960@cindex Alpha stack
12961@cindex MIPS stack
12962Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12963sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12964find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12965
8e04817f
AC
12966@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12967To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12968@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12969you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12970commands:
104c1213 12971
8e04817f
AC
12972@table @code
12973@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12974@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12975Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12976search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12977default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12978larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12979and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12980
8e04817f
AC
12981@item show heuristic-fence-post
12982Display the current limit.
12983@end table
104c1213
JM
12984
12985@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12986These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12987for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12988
104c1213 12989
8e04817f
AC
12990@node Controlling GDB
12991@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12992
12993You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12994@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12995data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12996described here.
12997
12998@menu
12999* Prompt:: Prompt
13000* Editing:: Command editing
13001* History:: Command history
13002* Screen Size:: Screen size
13003* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 13004* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
13005* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
13006* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
13007@end menu
13008
13009@node Prompt
13010@section Prompt
104c1213 13011
8e04817f 13012@cindex prompt
104c1213 13013
8e04817f
AC
13014@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
13015called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
13016can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
13017instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
13018the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
13019which one you are talking to.
104c1213 13020
8e04817f
AC
13021@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
13022prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
13023or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 13024
8e04817f
AC
13025@table @code
13026@kindex set prompt
13027@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
13028Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 13029
8e04817f
AC
13030@kindex show prompt
13031@item show prompt
13032Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
13033@end table
13034
8e04817f
AC
13035@node Editing
13036@section Command editing
13037@cindex readline
13038@cindex command line editing
104c1213 13039
8e04817f
AC
13040@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
13041@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
13042command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
13043or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
13044substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
13045debugging sessions.
104c1213 13046
8e04817f
AC
13047You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
13048command @code{set}.
104c1213 13049
8e04817f
AC
13050@table @code
13051@kindex set editing
13052@cindex editing
13053@item set editing
13054@itemx set editing on
13055Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 13056
8e04817f
AC
13057@item set editing off
13058Disable command line editing.
104c1213 13059
8e04817f
AC
13060@kindex show editing
13061@item show editing
13062Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
13063@end table
13064
8e04817f
AC
13065@node History
13066@section Command history
13067
13068@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
13069debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
13070happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
13071history facility.
104c1213
JM
13072
13073@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13074@cindex history substitution
13075@cindex history file
13076@kindex set history filename
13077@kindex GDBHISTFILE
13078@item set history filename @var{fname}
13079Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
13080This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
13081list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
13082exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
13083the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
13084to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
13085@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
13086is not set.
104c1213 13087
8e04817f
AC
13088@cindex history save
13089@kindex set history save
13090@item set history save
13091@itemx set history save on
13092Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
13093@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 13094
8e04817f
AC
13095@item set history save off
13096Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 13097
8e04817f
AC
13098@cindex history size
13099@kindex set history size
13100@item set history size @var{size}
13101Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
13102This defaults to the value of the environment variable
13103@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
13104@end table
13105
8e04817f
AC
13106@cindex history expansion
13107History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
13108@ifset have-readline-appendices
13109@xref{Event Designators}.
13110@end ifset
13111
13112Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
13113is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
13114@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
13115follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
13116a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
13117history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
13118@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
13119
13120The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
13121
13122@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13123@kindex set history expansion
13124@item set history expansion on
13125@itemx set history expansion
13126Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 13127
8e04817f
AC
13128@item set history expansion off
13129Disable history expansion.
104c1213 13130
8e04817f
AC
13131The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
13132editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
13133or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
13134@ifset have-readline-appendices
13135@xref{Command Line Editing}.
13136@end ifset
104c1213 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138@c @group
13139@kindex show history
13140@item show history
13141@itemx show history filename
13142@itemx show history save
13143@itemx show history size
13144@itemx show history expansion
13145These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
13146@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
13147@c @end group
13148@end table
13149
13150@table @code
13151@kindex shows
13152@item show commands
13153Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 13154
8e04817f
AC
13155@item show commands @var{n}
13156Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
13157
13158@item show commands +
13159Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
13160@end table
13161
8e04817f
AC
13162@node Screen Size
13163@section Screen size
13164@cindex size of screen
13165@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 13166
8e04817f
AC
13167Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
13168information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
13169@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
13170output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
13171to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
13172determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
13173printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
13174rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
13175
13176Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
13177driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
13178together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
13179@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
13180you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
13181width} commands:
13182
13183@table @code
13184@kindex set height
13185@kindex set width
13186@kindex show width
13187@kindex show height
13188@item set height @var{lpp}
13189@itemx show height
13190@itemx set width @var{cpl}
13191@itemx show width
13192These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
13193a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
13194commands display the current settings.
104c1213 13195
8e04817f
AC
13196If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
13197output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
13198file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 13199
8e04817f
AC
13200Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
13201from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
13202@end table
13203
8e04817f
AC
13204@node Numbers
13205@section Numbers
13206@cindex number representation
13207@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 13208
8e04817f
AC
13209You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
13210@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
13211@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
13212begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
13213default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
13214numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
13215change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
13216radix} command.
104c1213 13217
8e04817f
AC
13218@table @code
13219@kindex set input-radix
13220@item set input-radix @var{base}
13221Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
13222for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13223specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
13224example, any of
104c1213 13225
8e04817f
AC
13226@smallexample
13227set radix 012
13228set radix 10.
13229set radix 0xa
13230@end smallexample
104c1213 13231
8e04817f
AC
13232@noindent
13233sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
13234leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 13235
8e04817f
AC
13236@kindex set output-radix
13237@item set output-radix @var{base}
13238Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
13239for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13240specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 13241
8e04817f
AC
13242@kindex show input-radix
13243@item show input-radix
13244Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 13245
8e04817f
AC
13246@kindex show output-radix
13247@item show output-radix
13248Display the current default base for numeric display.
13249@end table
104c1213 13250
1e698235
DJ
13251@node ABI
13252@section Configuring the current ABI
13253
13254@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
13255application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
13256conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
13257current ABI.
13258
98b45e30
DJ
13259@cindex OS ABI
13260@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 13261@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
13262
13263One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
b383017d 13264system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
98b45e30
DJ
13265@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
13266but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
13267One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
13268an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
13269not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
13270platform provides.
13271
13272@table @code
13273@item show osabi
13274Show the OS ABI currently in use.
13275
13276@item set osabi
13277With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
13278
13279@item set osabi @var{abi}
13280Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
13281@end table
13282
1e698235
DJ
13283@cindex float promotion
13284@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
13285
13286Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
13287function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
13288(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
13289according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
13290(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
13291@code{double} and then passed.
13292
13293Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
13294a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
13295as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
13296
13297@table @code
13298@item set coerce-float-to-double
13299@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
13300Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
13301to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
13302
13303@item set coerce-float-to-double off
13304Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
13305functions.
13306@end table
13307
f1212245
DJ
13308@kindex set cp-abi
13309@kindex show cp-abi
13310@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
13311objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
13312used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
13313programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
13314multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
13315program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
13316Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
13317before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
13318``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
13319use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
13320``auto''.
13321
13322@table @code
13323@item show cp-abi
13324Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
13325
13326@item set cp-abi
13327With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
13328
13329@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
13330@itemx set cp-abi auto
13331Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
13332@end table
13333
8e04817f
AC
13334@node Messages/Warnings
13335@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 13336
8e04817f
AC
13337By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13338running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13339command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13340internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 13341
8e04817f
AC
13342Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13343which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13344see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 13345
8e04817f
AC
13346@table @code
13347@kindex set verbose
13348@item set verbose on
13349Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 13350
8e04817f
AC
13351@item set verbose off
13352Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 13353
8e04817f
AC
13354@kindex show verbose
13355@item show verbose
13356Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13357@end table
104c1213 13358
8e04817f
AC
13359By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13360object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13361find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13362symbol files}).
104c1213 13363
8e04817f 13364@table @code
104c1213 13365
8e04817f
AC
13366@kindex set complaints
13367@item set complaints @var{limit}
13368Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13369unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13370@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13371to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 13372
8e04817f
AC
13373@kindex show complaints
13374@item show complaints
13375Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 13376
8e04817f 13377@end table
104c1213 13378
8e04817f
AC
13379By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13380lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13381you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 13382
474c8240 13383@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13384(@value{GDBP}) run
13385The program being debugged has been started already.
13386Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 13387@end smallexample
104c1213 13388
8e04817f
AC
13389If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13390commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 13391
8e04817f 13392@table @code
104c1213 13393
8e04817f
AC
13394@kindex set confirm
13395@cindex flinching
13396@cindex confirmation
13397@cindex stupid questions
13398@item set confirm off
13399Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 13400
8e04817f
AC
13401@item set confirm on
13402Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 13403
8e04817f
AC
13404@kindex show confirm
13405@item show confirm
13406Displays state of confirmation requests.
13407
13408@end table
104c1213 13409
8e04817f
AC
13410@node Debugging Output
13411@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 13412@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13413@kindex set debug arch
13414@item set debug arch
13415Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13416@kindex show debug arch
13417@item show debug arch
13418Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13419@kindex set debug event
13420@item set debug event
13421Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13422default is off.
13423@kindex show debug event
13424@item show debug event
13425Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13426info.
13427@kindex set debug expression
13428@item set debug expression
13429Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13430default is off.
13431@kindex show debug expression
13432@item show debug expression
13433Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13434debugging info.
7453dc06
AC
13435@kindex set debug frame
13436@item set debug frame
13437Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13438default is off.
13439@kindex show debug frame
13440@item show debug frame
13441Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13442info.
2b4855ab
AC
13443@kindex set debug observer
13444@item set debug observer
13445Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
13446includes info such as the notification of observable events.
13447@kindex show debug observer
13448@item show debug observer
13449Displays the current state of observer debugging.
8e04817f
AC
13450@kindex set debug overload
13451@item set debug overload
13452Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13453info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13454is off.
13455@kindex show debug overload
13456@item show debug overload
13457Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13458debugging info.
13459@kindex set debug remote
13460@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13461@cindex serial connections, debugging
13462@item set debug remote
13463Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13464the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13465@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13466@kindex show debug remote
13467@item show debug remote
13468Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13469@kindex set debug serial
13470@item set debug serial
13471Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13472default is off.
13473@kindex show debug serial
13474@item show debug serial
13475Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13476info.
13477@kindex set debug target
13478@item set debug target
13479Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13480includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
701b08bb
DJ
13481default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
13482value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
13483until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
8e04817f
AC
13484@kindex show debug target
13485@item show debug target
13486Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13487info.
13488@kindex set debug varobj
13489@item set debug varobj
13490Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13491info. The default is off.
13492@kindex show debug varobj
13493@item show debug varobj
13494Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13495debugging info.
13496@end table
104c1213 13497
8e04817f
AC
13498@node Sequences
13499@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 13500
8e04817f
AC
13501Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13502command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13503commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13504files.
104c1213 13505
8e04817f
AC
13506@menu
13507* Define:: User-defined commands
13508* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13509* Command Files:: Command files
13510* Output:: Commands for controlled output
13511@end menu
104c1213 13512
8e04817f
AC
13513@node Define
13514@section User-defined commands
104c1213 13515
8e04817f
AC
13516@cindex user-defined command
13517A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13518which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13519@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13520separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13521via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 13522
8e04817f
AC
13523@smallexample
13524define adder
13525 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13526@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
13527
13528@noindent
8e04817f 13529To execute the command use:
104c1213 13530
8e04817f
AC
13531@smallexample
13532adder 1 2 3
13533@end smallexample
104c1213 13534
8e04817f
AC
13535@noindent
13536This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13537its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13538reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13539functions calls.
104c1213
JM
13540
13541@table @code
104c1213 13542
8e04817f
AC
13543@kindex define
13544@item define @var{commandname}
13545Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13546by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 13547
8e04817f
AC
13548The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13549which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13550commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13551
8e04817f
AC
13552@kindex if
13553@kindex else
13554@item if
13555Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13556It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13557only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13558There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13559by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13560was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13561
8e04817f
AC
13562@kindex while
13563@item while
13564The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13565which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13566execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13567The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13568evaluates to true.
104c1213 13569
8e04817f
AC
13570@kindex document
13571@item document @var{commandname}
13572Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13573accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13574defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13575reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13576After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13577@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 13578
8e04817f
AC
13579You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13580documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13581does not change the documentation.
104c1213 13582
8e04817f
AC
13583@kindex help user-defined
13584@item help user-defined
13585List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13586(if any) for each.
104c1213 13587
8e04817f
AC
13588@kindex show user
13589@item show user
13590@itemx show user @var{commandname}
13591Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13592not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13593definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 13594
20f01a46
DH
13595@kindex show max-user-call-depth
13596@kindex set max-user-call-depth
13597@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
13598@itemx set max-user-call-depth
13599The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13600levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13601infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 13602
104c1213
JM
13603@end table
13604
8e04817f
AC
13605When user-defined commands are executed, the
13606commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13607stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 13608
8e04817f
AC
13609If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13610without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13611commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13612messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 13613
8e04817f
AC
13614@node Hooks
13615@section User-defined command hooks
13616@cindex command hooks
13617@cindex hooks, for commands
13618@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 13619
8e04817f
AC
13620@kindex hook
13621@kindex hook-
13622You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13623command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13624command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13625before that command.
104c1213 13626
8e04817f
AC
13627@cindex hooks, post-command
13628@kindex hookpost
13629@kindex hookpost-
13630A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13631Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13632@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13633that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13634pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 13635
8e04817f
AC
13636It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13637occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 13638
8e04817f
AC
13639@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13640@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 13641
8e04817f
AC
13642@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13643In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13644(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13645execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13646displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 13647
8e04817f
AC
13648For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13649single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13650you could define:
104c1213 13651
474c8240 13652@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13653define hook-stop
13654handle SIGALRM nopass
13655end
104c1213 13656
8e04817f
AC
13657define hook-run
13658handle SIGALRM pass
13659end
104c1213 13660
8e04817f
AC
13661define hook-continue
13662handle SIGLARM pass
13663end
474c8240 13664@end smallexample
104c1213 13665
8e04817f 13666As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
b383017d 13667command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
8e04817f 13668you could define:
104c1213 13669
474c8240 13670@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13671define hook-echo
13672echo <<<---
13673end
104c1213 13674
8e04817f
AC
13675define hookpost-echo
13676echo --->>>\n
13677end
104c1213 13678
8e04817f
AC
13679(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13680<<<---Hello World--->>>
13681(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13682
474c8240 13683@end smallexample
104c1213 13684
8e04817f
AC
13685You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13686not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13687name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13688@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13689@c or not?
13690If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13691@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13692(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13693
8e04817f
AC
13694If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13695get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13696
8e04817f
AC
13697@node Command Files
13698@section Command files
c906108c 13699
8e04817f
AC
13700@cindex command files
13701A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13702commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13703An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13704the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13705
8e04817f
AC
13706@cindex init file
13707@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13708@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13709When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13710@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13711port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13712limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13713During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13714
8e04817f
AC
13715@enumerate
13716@item
13717Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13718DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13719@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13720
8e04817f
AC
13721@item
13722Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13723
8e04817f
AC
13724@item
13725Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13726
8e04817f
AC
13727@item
13728Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13729@end enumerate
c906108c 13730
8e04817f
AC
13731The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13732complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13733and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13734option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13735
8e04817f
AC
13736@cindex init file name
13737On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13738different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13739form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13740different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13741environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13742
8e04817f
AC
13743@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13744@itemize @bullet
13745@item
13746VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13747
8e04817f
AC
13748@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13749@item
13750OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13751
8e04817f
AC
13752@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13753@item
13754ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13755@end itemize
c906108c 13756
8e04817f
AC
13757You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13758@code{source} command:
c906108c 13759
8e04817f
AC
13760@table @code
13761@kindex source
13762@item source @var{filename}
13763Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13764@end table
13765
8e04817f 13766The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13767printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13768execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13769
8e04817f
AC
13770Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13771without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13772normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13773when called from command files.
c906108c 13774
8e04817f
AC
13775@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13776mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13777standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13778not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13779the next command.
c906108c 13780
474c8240 13781@smallexample
8e04817f 13782gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13783@end smallexample
c906108c 13784
8e04817f
AC
13785(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13786will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13787would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13788
8e04817f
AC
13789@node Output
13790@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13791
8e04817f
AC
13792During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13793@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13794explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13795describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13796want.
c906108c
SS
13797
13798@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13799@kindex echo
13800@item echo @var{text}
13801@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13802@c because it is not in ANSI.
13803Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13804@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13805newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13806In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13807by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13808string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13809trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13810To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13811@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13812
8e04817f
AC
13813A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13814the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13815
474c8240 13816@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13817echo This is some text\n\
13818which is continued\n\
13819onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13820@end smallexample
c906108c 13821
8e04817f 13822produces the same output as
c906108c 13823
474c8240 13824@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13825echo This is some text\n
13826echo which is continued\n
13827echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13828@end smallexample
c906108c 13829
8e04817f
AC
13830@kindex output
13831@item output @var{expression}
13832Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13833newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13834value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13835on expressions.
c906108c 13836
8e04817f
AC
13837@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13838Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13839the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13840formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13841
8e04817f
AC
13842@kindex printf
13843@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13844Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13845@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13846either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13847@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13848subroutine
13849@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13850@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13851@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13852@c supported.
c906108c 13853
474c8240 13854@smallexample
8e04817f 13855printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13856@end smallexample
c906108c 13857
8e04817f 13858For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13859
8e04817f
AC
13860@smallexample
13861printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13862@end smallexample
c906108c 13863
8e04817f
AC
13864The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13865string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13866letter.
c906108c
SS
13867@end table
13868
21c294e6
AC
13869@node Interpreters
13870@chapter Command Interpreters
13871@cindex command interpreters
13872
13873@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13874infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13875between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13876
13877@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13878interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13879and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13880describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13881
13882By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13883However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13884interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13885startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13886
13887@table @code
13888@item console
13889@cindex console interpreter
13890The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13891used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13892@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13893
13894@item mi
13895@cindex mi interpreter
13896The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13897by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13898or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13899Interface}.
13900
13901@item mi2
13902@cindex mi2 interpreter
13903The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13904
13905@item mi1
13906@cindex mi1 interpreter
13907The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13908
13909@end table
13910
13911@cindex invoke another interpreter
13912The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13913switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13914precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13915enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13916@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13917the IDE inoperable!
13918
13919@kindex interpreter-exec
13920Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13921commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13922command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13923@code{interpreter-exec} command:
13924
13925@smallexample
13926interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13927@end smallexample
13928
13929@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13930@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13931
8e04817f
AC
13932@node TUI
13933@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13934@cindex TUI
d0d5df6f 13935@cindex Text User Interface
c906108c 13936
8e04817f
AC
13937@menu
13938* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13939* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13940* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13941* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13942* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13943@end menu
c906108c 13944
d0d5df6f
AC
13945The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
13946interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
13947file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
13948commands in separate text windows.
13949
13950The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
13951@pindex gdbtui
13952@samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
c906108c 13953
8e04817f
AC
13954@node TUI Overview
13955@section TUI overview
c906108c 13956
8e04817f
AC
13957The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13958@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13959
8e04817f
AC
13960@itemize @bullet
13961@item
13962A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13963windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13964
8e04817f
AC
13965@item
13966A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13967the TUI.
13968@end itemize
c906108c 13969
8e04817f
AC
13970In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13971on the terminal:
c906108c 13972
8e04817f
AC
13973@table @emph
13974@item command
13975This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13976prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13977managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13978window is always visible.
c906108c 13979
8e04817f
AC
13980@item source
13981The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13982line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13983
8e04817f
AC
13984@item assembly
13985The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13986
8e04817f
AC
13987@item register
13988This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13989a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
6a1b180d 13990changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13991
c906108c
SS
13992@end table
13993
269c21fe
SC
13994The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13995by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13996Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13997indicates the breakpoint type:
13998
13999@table @code
14000@item B
14001Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
14002
14003@item b
14004Breakpoint which was never hit.
14005
14006@item H
14007Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
14008
14009@item h
14010Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
14011
14012@end table
14013
14014The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
14015
14016@table @code
14017@item +
14018Breakpoint is enabled.
14019
14020@item -
14021Breakpoint is disabled.
14022
14023@end table
14024
8e04817f
AC
14025The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
14026and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
14027changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
14028These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
14029layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
14030The following layouts are available:
c906108c 14031
8e04817f
AC
14032@itemize @bullet
14033@item
14034source
2df3850c 14035
8e04817f
AC
14036@item
14037assembly
14038
14039@item
14040source and assembly
14041
14042@item
14043source and registers
c906108c 14044
8e04817f
AC
14045@item
14046assembly and registers
2df3850c 14047
8e04817f 14048@end itemize
c906108c 14049
b7bb15bc
SC
14050On top of the command window a status line gives various information
14051concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
14052updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
14053are displayed:
14054
14055@table @emph
14056@item target
14057Indicates the current gdb target
14058(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14059
14060@item process
14061Gives information about the current process or thread number.
14062When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
14063
14064@item function
14065Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
14066The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
14067When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
14068the string @code{??} is displayed.
14069
14070@item line
14071Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
14072When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
14073
14074@item pc
14075Indicates the current program counter address.
14076
14077@end table
14078
8e04817f
AC
14079@node TUI Keys
14080@section TUI Key Bindings
14081@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 14082
8e04817f
AC
14083The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
14084(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
14085They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
14086directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
14087a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
14088@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 14089are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 14090
8e04817f
AC
14091@table @kbd
14092@kindex C-x C-a
14093@item C-x C-a
14094@kindex C-x a
14095@itemx C-x a
14096@kindex C-x A
14097@itemx C-x A
14098Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
14099the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
14100its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
14101mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
14102The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 14103
8e04817f
AC
14104@kindex C-x 1
14105@item C-x 1
14106Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
14107either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
14108is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 14109
8e04817f 14110Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 14111
8e04817f
AC
14112@kindex C-x 2
14113@item C-x 2
14114Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
14115layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
14116When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
14117previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 14118
8e04817f 14119Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 14120
72ffddc9
SC
14121@kindex C-x o
14122@item C-x o
14123Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
14124(like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
14125gives the focus to the next TUI window.
14126
14127Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
14128
7cf36c78
SC
14129@kindex C-x s
14130@item C-x s
14131Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
14132(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
14133
c906108c
SS
14134@end table
14135
8e04817f 14136The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 14137
8e04817f
AC
14138@table @key
14139@kindex PgUp
14140@item PgUp
14141Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 14142
8e04817f
AC
14143@kindex PgDn
14144@item PgDn
14145Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 14146
8e04817f
AC
14147@kindex Up
14148@item Up
14149Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 14150
8e04817f
AC
14151@kindex Down
14152@item Down
14153Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 14154
8e04817f
AC
14155@kindex Left
14156@item Left
14157Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 14158
8e04817f
AC
14159@kindex Right
14160@item Right
14161Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 14162
8e04817f
AC
14163@kindex C-L
14164@item C-L
14165Refresh the screen.
c906108c 14166
8e04817f 14167@end table
c906108c 14168
8e04817f 14169In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
72ffddc9
SC
14170for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
14171active window is the command window. When the command window
14172does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
14173key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
8e04817f 14174
7cf36c78
SC
14175@node TUI Single Key Mode
14176@section TUI Single Key Mode
14177@cindex TUI single key mode
14178
14179The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
14180key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
b383017d 14181some gdb commands.
7cf36c78
SC
14182
14183@table @kbd
14184@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14185@item c
14186continue
14187
14188@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14189@item d
14190down
14191
14192@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14193@item f
14194finish
14195
14196@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14197@item n
14198next
14199
14200@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14201@item q
14202exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
14203
14204@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14205@item r
14206run
14207
14208@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14209@item s
14210step
14211
14212@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14213@item u
14214up
14215
14216@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14217@item v
14218info locals
14219
14220@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14221@item w
14222where
14223
14224@end table
14225
14226Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
14227The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
14228it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
14229with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
14230@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
14231this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
14232
14233
8e04817f
AC
14234@node TUI Commands
14235@section TUI specific commands
14236@cindex TUI commands
14237
14238The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
14239These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
14240the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
14241is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
14242in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
14243
14244@table @code
3d757584
SC
14245@item info win
14246@kindex info win
14247List and give the size of all displayed windows.
14248
8e04817f
AC
14249@item layout next
14250@kindex layout next
14251Display the next layout.
2df3850c 14252
8e04817f
AC
14253@item layout prev
14254@kindex layout prev
14255Display the previous layout.
c906108c 14256
8e04817f
AC
14257@item layout src
14258@kindex layout src
14259Display the source window only.
c906108c 14260
8e04817f
AC
14261@item layout asm
14262@kindex layout asm
14263Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 14264
8e04817f
AC
14265@item layout split
14266@kindex layout split
14267Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 14268
8e04817f
AC
14269@item layout regs
14270@kindex layout regs
14271Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
14272
14273@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
14274@kindex focus
14275Set the focus to the named window.
14276This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
14277can be affected to another window.
c906108c 14278
8e04817f
AC
14279@item refresh
14280@kindex refresh
14281Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 14282
6a1b180d
SC
14283@item tui reg float
14284@kindex tui reg
14285Show the floating point registers in the register window.
14286
14287@item tui reg general
14288Show the general registers in the register window.
14289
14290@item tui reg next
14291Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
14292their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
14293following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
14294@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
14295
14296@item tui reg system
14297Show the system registers in the register window.
14298
8e04817f
AC
14299@item update
14300@kindex update
14301Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 14302
8e04817f
AC
14303@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
14304@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
14305@kindex winheight
14306Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
14307lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
14308decrease it.
2df3850c 14309
c906108c
SS
14310@end table
14311
8e04817f
AC
14312@node TUI Configuration
14313@section TUI configuration variables
14314@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 14315
8e04817f
AC
14316The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
14317appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 14318
8e04817f
AC
14319@table @code
14320@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
14321@kindex set tui border-kind
14322Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
14323The possible values are the following:
14324@table @code
14325@item space
14326Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 14327
8e04817f
AC
14328@item ascii
14329Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 14330
8e04817f
AC
14331@item acs
14332Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14333drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 14334
8e04817f 14335@end table
c78b4128 14336
8e04817f
AC
14337@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14338@kindex set tui active-border-mode
14339Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14340The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14341@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 14342
8e04817f
AC
14343@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14344@kindex set tui border-mode
14345Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14346The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14347@table @code
14348@item normal
14349Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 14350
8e04817f
AC
14351@item standout
14352Use standout mode.
c906108c 14353
8e04817f
AC
14354@item reverse
14355Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 14356
8e04817f
AC
14357@item half
14358Use half bright mode.
c906108c 14359
8e04817f
AC
14360@item half-standout
14361Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 14362
8e04817f
AC
14363@item bold
14364Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 14365
8e04817f
AC
14366@item bold-standout
14367Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 14368
8e04817f 14369@end table
c78b4128 14370
8e04817f 14371@end table
c78b4128 14372
8e04817f
AC
14373@node Emacs
14374@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 14375
8e04817f
AC
14376@cindex Emacs
14377@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14378A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14379edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14380@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14381
8e04817f
AC
14382To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14383executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14384@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14385created Emacs buffer.
14386@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 14387
8e04817f
AC
14388Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14389things:
c906108c 14390
8e04817f
AC
14391@itemize @bullet
14392@item
14393All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14394@end itemize
c906108c 14395
8e04817f
AC
14396This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14397and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 14398
8e04817f
AC
14399This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14400commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14401in this way.
bf0184be 14402
8e04817f
AC
14403All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14404with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14405way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14406stop.
bf0184be 14407
8e04817f 14408@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 14409@item
8e04817f
AC
14410@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14411@end itemize
bf0184be 14412
8e04817f
AC
14413Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14414source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14415left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14416source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14417and the source.
bf0184be 14418
8e04817f
AC
14419Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14420usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 14421
64fabec2
AC
14422If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
14423gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
14424your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
14425sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
14426with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
14427program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
14428some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
14429@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
14430buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
14431
14432The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
14433line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
14434the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
14435on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
14436
14437By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
14438need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
14439keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
14440customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
14441one you want.
8e04817f
AC
14442
14443In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14444addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 14445
8e04817f
AC
14446@table @kbd
14447@item C-h m
14448Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 14449
64fabec2 14450@item C-c C-s
8e04817f
AC
14451Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14452update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 14453
64fabec2 14454@item C-c C-n
8e04817f
AC
14455Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14456calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14457to show the current file and location.
c906108c 14458
64fabec2 14459@item C-c C-i
8e04817f
AC
14460Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14461display window accordingly.
c906108c 14462
8e04817f
AC
14463@item C-c C-f
14464Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14465@code{finish} command.
c906108c 14466
64fabec2 14467@item C-c C-r
8e04817f
AC
14468Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14469command.
b433d00b 14470
64fabec2 14471@item C-c <
8e04817f
AC
14472Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14473(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14474like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 14475
64fabec2 14476@item C-c >
8e04817f
AC
14477Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14478@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
8e04817f 14479@end table
c906108c 14480
64fabec2 14481In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
8e04817f 14482tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 14483
64fabec2
AC
14484If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
14485shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
14486point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
14487current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
14488Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
14489current one.
14490
8e04817f
AC
14491If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14492it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14493request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14494the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14495frame.
c906108c 14496
8e04817f
AC
14497The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14498which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14499the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14500communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14501delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14502to correspond properly with the code.
b383017d 14503
64fabec2
AC
14504The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
14505detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
14506the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
c906108c 14507
8e04817f
AC
14508@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14509@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14510@ignore
14511@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14512@kindex Epoch
14513@kindex inspect
c906108c 14514
8e04817f
AC
14515Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14516called the @code{epoch}
14517environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14518@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14519each value is printed in its own window.
14520@end ignore
c906108c 14521
922fbb7b
AC
14522
14523@node GDB/MI
14524@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14525
14526@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14527
14528@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14529@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14530specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14531the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14532
14533This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14534in the form of a reference manual.
14535
14536Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14537features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14538
14539@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14540
14541@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14542This chapter uses the following notation:
14543
14544@itemize @bullet
14545@item
14546@code{|} separates two alternatives.
14547
14548@item
14549@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14550it may or may not be given.
14551
14552@item
14553@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14554may repeat zero or more times.
14555
14556@item
14557@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14558may repeat one or more times.
14559
14560@item
14561@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14562@end itemize
14563
14564@ignore
14565@heading Dependencies
14566@end ignore
14567
14568@heading Acknowledgments
14569
14570In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14571Elena Zannoni.
14572
14573@menu
14574* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14575* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14576* GDB/MI Output Records::
14577* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14578* GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14579* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14580* GDB/MI Program Control::
14581* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14582@ignore
14583* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14584* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14585* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14586@end ignore
14587* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14588* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14589* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14590* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14591* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14592* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14593@end menu
14594
14595@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14596@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14597@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14598
14599@menu
14600* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14601* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14602* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14603@end menu
14604
14605@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14606@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14607
14608@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14609@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14610@table @code
14611@item @var{command} @expansion{}
14612@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14613
14614@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14615@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14616@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14617
14618@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14619@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14620@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14621
14622@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14623"any sequence of digits"
14624
14625@item @var{option} @expansion{}
14626@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14627
14628@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14629@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14630
14631@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14632@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14633
14634@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14635@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14636"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14637
14638@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14639@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14640
14641@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14642@code{CR | CR-LF}
14643@end table
14644
14645@noindent
14646Notes:
14647
14648@itemize @bullet
14649@item
14650The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14651output is described below.
14652
14653@item
14654The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14655finishes.
14656
14657@item
14658Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14659list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14660followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14661parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14662@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14663@end itemize
14664
14665Pragmatics:
14666
14667@itemize @bullet
14668@item
14669We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14670
14671@item
14672We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14673@end itemize
14674
14675@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14676@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14677
14678@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14679@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14680The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14681followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14682is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14683terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14684
14685If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14686corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14687@var{token}.
14688
14689@table @code
14690@item @var{output} @expansion{}
14691@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14692
14693@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14694@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14695
14696@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14697@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14698
14699@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14700@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14701
14702@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14703@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14704
14705@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14706@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14707
14708@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14709@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14710
14711@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14712@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14713
14714@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14715@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14716
14717@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14718@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14719depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14720
14721@item @var{result} @expansion{}
14722@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14723
14724@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14725@code{ @var{string} }
14726
14727@item @var{value} @expansion{}
14728@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14729
14730@item @var{const} @expansion{}
14731@code{@var{c-string}}
14732
14733@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14734@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14735
14736@item @var{list} @expansion{}
14737@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14738@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14739
14740@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14741@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14742
14743@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14744@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14745
14746@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14747@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14748
14749@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14750@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14751
14752@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14753@code{CR | CR-LF}
14754
14755@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14756@emph{any sequence of digits}.
14757@end table
14758
14759@noindent
14760Notes:
14761
14762@itemize @bullet
14763@item
14764All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14765
14766@item
14767The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14768command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14769@var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14770original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14771
14772@item
14773@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14774@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14775progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14776prefixed by @samp{+}.
14777
14778@item
14779@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14780@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14781(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14782@samp{*}.
14783
14784@item
14785@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14786@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14787client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14788output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14789
14790@item
14791@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14792@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14793console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14794output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14795
14796@item
14797@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14798@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14799All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14800
14801@item
14802@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14803@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14804instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14805the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14806
14807@item
14808@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14809New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14810@var{values}.
14811
14812
14813@end itemize
14814
14815@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14816details about the various output records.
14817
14818@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14819@subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14820@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14821
14822This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14823the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14824following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14825the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14826
14827@subsubheading Target Stop
14828@c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14829Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14830
14831@smallexample
14832-> -stop
14833<- (@value{GDBP})
14834@end smallexample
14835
14836@noindent
14837and later:
14838
14839@smallexample
14840<- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14841<- (@value{GDBP})
14842@end smallexample
14843
14844@subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14845
14846Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14847@sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14848
14849@smallexample
14850-> print 1+2
14851<- &"print 1+2\n"
14852<- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14853<- ^done
14854<- (@value{GDBP})
14855@end smallexample
14856
14857@subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14858
14859@smallexample
14860-> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14861<- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14862<- (@value{GDBP})
14863@end smallexample
14864
14865@subsubheading A Bad Command
14866
14867Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14868
14869@smallexample
14870-> -rubbish
14871<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14872<- (@value{GDBP})
14873@end smallexample
14874
14875@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14876@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14877@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14878
14879@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14880@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14881To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14882accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14883commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14884respond.
14885
14886This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14887clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14888is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14889behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14890an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14891
14892@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14893@node GDB/MI Output Records
14894@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14895
14896@menu
14897* GDB/MI Result Records::
14898* GDB/MI Stream Records::
14899* GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14900@end menu
14901
14902@node GDB/MI Result Records
14903@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14904
14905@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14906@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14907In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14908@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14909
14910@table @code
14911@findex ^done
14912@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14913The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14914values.
14915
14916@item "^running"
14917@findex ^running
14918@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14919The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14920running.
14921
14922@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14923@findex ^error
14924The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14925error message.
14926@end table
14927
14928@node GDB/MI Stream Records
14929@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14930
14931@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14932@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14933@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14934target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14935funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14936
14937Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14938identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14939Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14940@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14941line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14942
14943@table @code
14944@item "~" @var{string-output}
14945The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14946CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14947
14948@item "@@" @var{string-output}
14949The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14950target.
14951
14952@item "&" @var{string-output}
14953The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14954internals.
14955@end table
14956
14957@node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14958@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14959
14960@cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14961@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14962@dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14963additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14964consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14965target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14966
14967The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14968
14969@table @code
14970@item "*" "stop"
14971@end table
14972
14973
14974@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14975@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14976@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14977
14978The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14979commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14980
14981Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14982readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14983Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14984not yet implemented.
14985
14986@subheading Motivation
14987
14988The motivation for this collection of commands.
14989
14990@subheading Introduction
14991
14992A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14993
14994@subheading Commands
14995
14996For each command in the block, the following is described:
14997
14998@subsubheading Synopsis
14999
15000@smallexample
15001 -command @var{args}@dots{}
15002@end smallexample
15003
15004@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15005
15006The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
15007
15008@subsubheading Result
15009
15010@subsubheading Out-of-band
15011
15012@subsubheading Notes
15013
15014@subsubheading Example
15015
15016
15017@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15018@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
15019@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
15020
15021@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
15022@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
15023This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
15024breakpoints.
15025
15026@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
15027@findex -break-after
15028
15029@subsubheading Synopsis
15030
15031@smallexample
15032 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
15033@end smallexample
15034
15035The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
15036hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
15037the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
15038@samp{-break-list} command below.
15039
15040@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15041
15042The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
15043
15044@subsubheading Example
15045
15046@smallexample
15047(@value{GDBP})
15048-break-insert main
15049^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
15050(@value{GDBP})
15051-break-after 1 3
15052~
15053^done
15054(@value{GDBP})
15055-break-list
15056^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15057hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15058@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15059@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15060@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15061@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15062@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15063body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15064addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
15065ignore="3"@}]@}
15066(@value{GDBP})
15067@end smallexample
15068
15069@ignore
15070@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
15071@findex -break-catch
15072
15073@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
15074@findex -break-commands
15075@end ignore
15076
15077
15078@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
15079@findex -break-condition
15080
15081@subsubheading Synopsis
15082
15083@smallexample
15084 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
15085@end smallexample
15086
15087Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
15088@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
15089@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
15090command below).
15091
15092@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15093
15094The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
15095
15096@subsubheading Example
15097
15098@smallexample
15099(@value{GDBP})
15100-break-condition 1 1
15101^done
15102(@value{GDBP})
15103-break-list
15104^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15105hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15106@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15107@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15108@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15109@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15110@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15111body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15112addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
15113times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
15114(@value{GDBP})
15115@end smallexample
15116
15117@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
15118@findex -break-delete
15119
15120@subsubheading Synopsis
15121
15122@smallexample
15123 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
15124@end smallexample
15125
15126Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
15127list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
15128
15129@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15130
15131The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
15132
15133@subsubheading Example
15134
15135@smallexample
15136(@value{GDBP})
15137-break-delete 1
15138^done
15139(@value{GDBP})
15140-break-list
15141^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15142hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15143@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15144@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15145@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15146@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15147@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15148body=[]@}
15149(@value{GDBP})
15150@end smallexample
15151
15152@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
15153@findex -break-disable
15154
15155@subsubheading Synopsis
15156
15157@smallexample
15158 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
15159@end smallexample
15160
15161Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
15162break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
15163
15164@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15165
15166The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
15167
15168@subsubheading Example
15169
15170@smallexample
15171(@value{GDBP})
15172-break-disable 2
15173^done
15174(@value{GDBP})
15175-break-list
15176^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15177hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15178@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15179@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15180@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15181@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15182@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15183body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
15184addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
15185(@value{GDBP})
15186@end smallexample
15187
15188@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
15189@findex -break-enable
15190
15191@subsubheading Synopsis
15192
15193@smallexample
15194 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
15195@end smallexample
15196
15197Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
15198
15199@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15200
15201The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
15202
15203@subsubheading Example
15204
15205@smallexample
15206(@value{GDBP})
15207-break-enable 2
15208^done
15209(@value{GDBP})
15210-break-list
15211^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15212hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15213@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15214@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15215@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15216@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15217@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15218body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15219addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
15220(@value{GDBP})
15221@end smallexample
15222
15223@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
15224@findex -break-info
15225
15226@subsubheading Synopsis
15227
15228@smallexample
15229 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
15230@end smallexample
15231
15232@c REDUNDANT???
15233Get information about a single breakpoint.
15234
15235@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15236
15237The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
15238
15239@subsubheading Example
15240N.A.
15241
15242@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
15243@findex -break-insert
15244
15245@subsubheading Synopsis
15246
15247@smallexample
15248 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
15249 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
15250 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
15251@end smallexample
15252
15253@noindent
15254If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
15255
15256@itemize @bullet
15257@item function
15258@c @item +offset
15259@c @item -offset
15260@c @item linenum
15261@item filename:linenum
15262@item filename:function
15263@item *address
15264@end itemize
15265
15266The possible optional parameters of this command are:
15267
15268@table @samp
15269@item -t
15270Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
15271@item -h
15272Insert a hardware breakpoint.
15273@item -c @var{condition}
15274Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
15275@item -i @var{ignore-count}
15276Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
15277@item -r
15278Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
15279given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
15280expresson.
15281@end table
15282
15283@subsubheading Result
15284
15285The result is in the form:
15286
15287@smallexample
15288 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
15289 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
15290@end smallexample
15291
15292@noindent
15293where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
15294is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
15295@var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
15296function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
15297
15298Note: this format is open to change.
15299@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
15300
15301@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15302
15303The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
15304@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
15305
15306@subsubheading Example
15307
15308@smallexample
15309(@value{GDBP})
15310-break-insert main
15311^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
15312(@value{GDBP})
15313-break-insert -t foo
15314^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15315(@value{GDBP})
15316-break-list
15317^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15318hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15319@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15320@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15321@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15322@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15323@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15324body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15325addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
15326bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
15327addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
15328(@value{GDBP})
15329-break-insert -r foo.*
15330~int foo(int, int);
15331^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15332(@value{GDBP})
15333@end smallexample
15334
15335@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
15336@findex -break-list
15337
15338@subsubheading Synopsis
15339
15340@smallexample
15341 -break-list
15342@end smallexample
15343
15344Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
15345
15346@table @samp
15347@item Number
15348number of the breakpoint
15349@item Type
15350type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
15351@item Disposition
15352should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
15353or @samp{nokeep}
15354@item Enabled
15355is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
15356@item Address
15357memory location at which the breakpoint is set
15358@item What
15359logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
15360name, line number
15361@item Times
15362number of times the breakpoint has been hit
15363@end table
15364
15365If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
15366@code{body} field is an empty list.
15367
15368@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15369
15370The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
15371
15372@subsubheading Example
15373
15374@smallexample
15375(@value{GDBP})
15376-break-list
15377^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15378hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15379@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15380@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15381@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15382@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15383@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15384body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15385addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
15386bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15387addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
15388(@value{GDBP})
15389@end smallexample
15390
15391Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
15392
15393@smallexample
15394(@value{GDBP})
15395-break-list
15396^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15397hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15398@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15399@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15400@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15401@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15402@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15403body=[]@}
15404(@value{GDBP})
15405@end smallexample
15406
15407@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
15408@findex -break-watch
15409
15410@subsubheading Synopsis
15411
15412@smallexample
15413 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
15414@end smallexample
15415
15416Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
15417@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
15418read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15419option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15420trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15421either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15422i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15423@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15424
15425Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15426breakpoints inserted.
15427
15428@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15429
15430The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15431@samp{rwatch}.
15432
15433@subsubheading Example
15434
15435Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15436
15437@smallexample
15438(@value{GDBP})
15439-break-watch x
15440^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15441(@value{GDBP})
15442-exec-continue
15443^running
15444^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15445value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15446frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15447(@value{GDBP})
15448@end smallexample
15449
15450Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15451the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15452for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15453
15454@smallexample
15455(@value{GDBP})
15456-break-watch C
15457^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15458(@value{GDBP})
15459-exec-continue
15460^running
15461^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15462wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15463frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15464file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15465(@value{GDBP})
15466-exec-continue
15467^running
15468^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15469frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15470value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15471file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15472(@value{GDBP})
15473@end smallexample
15474
15475Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15476execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15477deleted.
15478
15479@smallexample
15480(@value{GDBP})
15481-break-watch C
15482^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15483(@value{GDBP})
15484-break-list
15485^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15486hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15487@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15488@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15489@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15490@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15491@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15492body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15493addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15494file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15495bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15496enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15497(@value{GDBP})
15498-exec-continue
15499^running
15500^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15501value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15502frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15503file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15504(@value{GDBP})
15505-break-list
15506^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15507hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15508@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15509@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15510@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15511@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15512@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15513body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15514addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15515file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15516bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15517enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15518(@value{GDBP})
15519-exec-continue
15520^running
15521^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15522frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15523value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15524file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15525(@value{GDBP})
15526-break-list
15527^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15528hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15529@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15530@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15531@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15532@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15533@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15534body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15535addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15536file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15537(@value{GDBP})
15538@end smallexample
15539
15540@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15541@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15542@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15543
15544@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15545@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15546This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15547examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15548
15549@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15550@c @subheading -data-assign
15551@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15552@c @subsubheading GDB command
15553@c set variable
15554@c @subsubheading Example
15555@c N.A.
15556
15557@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15558@findex -data-disassemble
15559
15560@subsubheading Synopsis
15561
15562@smallexample
15563 -data-disassemble
15564 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15565 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15566 -- @var{mode}
15567@end smallexample
15568
15569@noindent
15570Where:
15571
15572@table @samp
15573@item @var{start-addr}
15574is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15575@item @var{end-addr}
15576is the end address
15577@item @var{filename}
15578is the name of the file to disassemble
15579@item @var{linenum}
15580is the line number to disassemble around
15581@item @var{lines}
15582is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15583the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15584specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15585@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15586@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15587displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15588@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15589are displayed.
15590@item @var{mode}
15591is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15592disassembly).
15593@end table
15594
15595@subsubheading Result
15596
15597The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15598
15599@itemize @bullet
15600@item Address
15601@item Func-name
15602@item Offset
15603@item Instruction
15604@end itemize
15605
15606Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15607directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15608
15609@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15610
15611There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15612
15613@subsubheading Example
15614
15615Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15616
15617@smallexample
15618(@value{GDBP})
15619-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15620^done,
15621asm_insns=[
15622@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15623inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15624@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15625inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15626@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15627inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15628@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15629inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15630@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15631inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15632(@value{GDBP})
15633@end smallexample
15634
15635Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15636@code{main}.
15637
15638@smallexample
15639-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15640^done,asm_insns=[
15641@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15642inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15643@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15644inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15645@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15646inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15647[@dots{}]
15648@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15649@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15650(@value{GDBP})
15651@end smallexample
15652
15653Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15654
15655@smallexample
15656(@value{GDBP})
15657-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15658^done,asm_insns=[
15659@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15660inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15661@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15662inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15663@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15664inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15665(@value{GDBP})
15666@end smallexample
15667
15668Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15669
15670@smallexample
15671(@value{GDBP})
15672-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15673^done,asm_insns=[
15674src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15675file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15676 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15677@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15678inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15679src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15680file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15681 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15682@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15683inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15684@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15685inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15686(@value{GDBP})
15687@end smallexample
15688
15689
15690@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15691@findex -data-evaluate-expression
15692
15693@subsubheading Synopsis
15694
15695@smallexample
15696 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15697@end smallexample
15698
15699Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15700inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15701If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15702
15703@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15704
15705The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15706@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15707@samp{gdb_eval} command.
15708
15709@subsubheading Example
15710
15711In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15712@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15713Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15714output.
15715
15716@smallexample
15717211-data-evaluate-expression A
15718211^done,value="1"
15719(@value{GDBP})
15720311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15721311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15722(@value{GDBP})
15723411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15724411^done,value="4"
15725(@value{GDBP})
15726511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15727511^done,value="4"
15728(@value{GDBP})
15729@end smallexample
15730
15731
15732@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15733@findex -data-list-changed-registers
15734
15735@subsubheading Synopsis
15736
15737@smallexample
15738 -data-list-changed-registers
15739@end smallexample
15740
15741Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15742
15743@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15744
15745@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15746has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15747
15748@subsubheading Example
15749
15750On a PPC MBX board:
15751
15752@smallexample
15753(@value{GDBP})
15754-exec-continue
15755^running
15756
15757(@value{GDBP})
15758*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15759args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15760(@value{GDBP})
15761-data-list-changed-registers
15762^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15763"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15764"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15765(@value{GDBP})
15766@end smallexample
15767
15768
15769@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15770@findex -data-list-register-names
15771
15772@subsubheading Synopsis
15773
15774@smallexample
15775 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15776@end smallexample
15777
15778Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15779are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15780integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15781names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15782consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15783include empty register names.
15784
15785@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15786
15787@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15788@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15789corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15790
15791@subsubheading Example
15792
15793For the PPC MBX board:
15794@smallexample
15795(@value{GDBP})
15796-data-list-register-names
15797^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15798"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15799"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15800"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15801"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15802"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15803"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15804(@value{GDBP})
15805-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15806^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15807(@value{GDBP})
15808@end smallexample
15809
15810@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15811@findex -data-list-register-values
15812
15813@subsubheading Synopsis
15814
15815@smallexample
15816 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15817@end smallexample
15818
15819Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15820which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15821list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15822numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15823
15824Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15825
15826@table @code
15827@item x
15828Hexadecimal
15829@item o
15830Octal
15831@item t
15832Binary
15833@item d
15834Decimal
15835@item r
15836Raw
15837@item N
15838Natural
15839@end table
15840
15841@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15842
15843The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15844all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15845
15846@subsubheading Example
15847
15848For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15849don't appear in the actual output):
15850
15851@smallexample
15852(@value{GDBP})
15853-data-list-register-values r 64 65
15854^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15855@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15856(@value{GDBP})
15857-data-list-register-values x
15858^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15859@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15860@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15861@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15862@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15863@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15864@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15865@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15866@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15867@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15868@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15869@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15870@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15871@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15872@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15873@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15874@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15875@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15876@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15877@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15878@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15879@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15880@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15881@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15882@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15883@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15884@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15885@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15886@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15887@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15888@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15889@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15890@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15891@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15892@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15893@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15894(@value{GDBP})
15895@end smallexample
15896
15897
15898@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15899@findex -data-read-memory
15900
15901@subsubheading Synopsis
15902
15903@smallexample
15904 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15905 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15906 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15907@end smallexample
15908
15909@noindent
15910where:
15911
15912@table @samp
15913@item @var{address}
15914An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15915read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15916quoted using the C convention.
15917
15918@item @var{word-format}
15919The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15920same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15921,Output formats}).
15922
15923@item @var{word-size}
15924The size of each memory word in bytes.
15925
15926@item @var{nr-rows}
15927The number of rows in the output table.
15928
15929@item @var{nr-cols}
15930The number of columns in the output table.
15931
15932@item @var{aschar}
15933If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15934value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15935member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15936characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15937
15938@item @var{byte-offset}
15939An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15940@end table
15941
15942This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15943@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15944@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15945(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15946of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15947using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15948in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15949@samp{addr}.
15950
15951The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15952@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15953@samp{prev-page}.
15954
15955@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15956
15957The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15958@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15959
15960@subsubheading Example
15961
15962Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15963@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15964word. Display each word in hex.
15965
15966@smallexample
15967(@value{GDBP})
159689-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
159699^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15970next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15971prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15972@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15973@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15974@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15975(@value{GDBP})
15976@end smallexample
15977
15978Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15979display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15980
15981@smallexample
15982(@value{GDBP})
159835-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
159845^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15985next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15986next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15987@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15988(@value{GDBP})
15989@end smallexample
15990
15991Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15992as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15993used as the non-printable character.
15994
15995@smallexample
15996(@value{GDBP})
159974-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
159984^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15999next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
16000next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
16001@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
16002@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
16003@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
16004@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
16005@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
16006@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
16007@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
16008@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
16009(@value{GDBP})
16010@end smallexample
16011
16012@subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
16013@findex -display-delete
16014
16015@subsubheading Synopsis
16016
16017@smallexample
16018 -display-delete @var{number}
16019@end smallexample
16020
16021Delete the display @var{number}.
16022
16023@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16024
16025The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
16026
16027@subsubheading Example
16028N.A.
16029
16030
16031@subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
16032@findex -display-disable
16033
16034@subsubheading Synopsis
16035
16036@smallexample
16037 -display-disable @var{number}
16038@end smallexample
16039
16040Disable display @var{number}.
16041
16042@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16043
16044The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
16045
16046@subsubheading Example
16047N.A.
16048
16049
16050@subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
16051@findex -display-enable
16052
16053@subsubheading Synopsis
16054
16055@smallexample
16056 -display-enable @var{number}
16057@end smallexample
16058
16059Enable display @var{number}.
16060
16061@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16062
16063The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
16064
16065@subsubheading Example
16066N.A.
16067
16068
16069@subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
16070@findex -display-insert
16071
16072@subsubheading Synopsis
16073
16074@smallexample
16075 -display-insert @var{expression}
16076@end smallexample
16077
16078Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
16079
16080@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16081
16082The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
16083
16084@subsubheading Example
16085N.A.
16086
16087
16088@subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
16089@findex -display-list
16090
16091@subsubheading Synopsis
16092
16093@smallexample
16094 -display-list
16095@end smallexample
16096
16097List the displays. Do not show the current values.
16098
16099@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16100
16101The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
16102
16103@subsubheading Example
16104N.A.
16105
16106
16107@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
16108@findex -environment-cd
16109
16110@subsubheading Synopsis
16111
16112@smallexample
16113 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
16114@end smallexample
16115
16116Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
16117
16118@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16119
16120The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
16121
16122@subsubheading Example
16123
16124@smallexample
16125(@value{GDBP})
16126-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
16127^done
16128(@value{GDBP})
16129@end smallexample
16130
16131
16132@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
16133@findex -environment-directory
16134
16135@subsubheading Synopsis
16136
16137@smallexample
16138 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
16139@end smallexample
16140
16141Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
16142If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
b383017d 16143search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
922fbb7b
AC
16144@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
16145occurs as normal.
b383017d 16146Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
922fbb7b
AC
16147multiple directories in a single command
16148results in the directories added to the beginning of the
16149search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
16150If blanks are needed as
16151part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
16152the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
b383017d 16153by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
922fbb7b
AC
16154character must not be used
16155in any directory name.
16156If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
16157
16158@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16159
16160The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
16161
16162@subsubheading Example
16163
16164@smallexample
16165(@value{GDBP})
16166-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
16167^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
16168(@value{GDBP})
16169-environment-directory ""
16170^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
16171(@value{GDBP})
16172-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
16173^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
16174(@value{GDBP})
16175-environment-directory -r
16176^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
16177(@value{GDBP})
16178@end smallexample
16179
16180
16181@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
16182@findex -environment-path
16183
16184@subsubheading Synopsis
16185
16186@smallexample
16187 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
16188@end smallexample
16189
16190Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
16191If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
b383017d
RM
16192search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
16193supplied in addition to the
922fbb7b
AC
16194@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
16195occurs as normal.
b383017d 16196Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
922fbb7b
AC
16197multiple directories in a single command
16198results in the directories added to the beginning of the
16199search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
16200If blanks are needed as
16201part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
16202the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
b383017d 16203by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
922fbb7b
AC
16204character must not be used
16205in any directory name.
16206If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
16207
16208
16209@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16210
16211The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
16212
16213@subsubheading Example
16214
16215@smallexample
16216(@value{GDBP})
b383017d 16217-environment-path
922fbb7b
AC
16218^done,path="/usr/bin"
16219(@value{GDBP})
16220-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
16221^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
16222(@value{GDBP})
16223-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
16224^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
16225(@value{GDBP})
16226@end smallexample
16227
16228
16229@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
16230@findex -environment-pwd
16231
16232@subsubheading Synopsis
16233
16234@smallexample
16235 -environment-pwd
16236@end smallexample
16237
16238Show the current working directory.
16239
16240@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16241
16242The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
16243
16244@subsubheading Example
16245
16246@smallexample
16247(@value{GDBP})
16248-environment-pwd
16249^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
16250(@value{GDBP})
16251@end smallexample
16252
16253@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16254@node GDB/MI Program Control
16255@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
16256
16257@subsubheading Program termination
16258
16259As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
16260it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
16261include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
16262
16263@subsubheading Examples
16264
16265@noindent
16266Program exited normally:
16267
16268@smallexample
16269(@value{GDBP})
16270-exec-run
16271^running
16272(@value{GDBP})
16273x = 55
16274*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
16275(@value{GDBP})
16276@end smallexample
16277
16278@noindent
16279Program exited exceptionally:
16280
16281@smallexample
16282(@value{GDBP})
16283-exec-run
16284^running
16285(@value{GDBP})
16286x = 55
16287*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
16288(@value{GDBP})
16289@end smallexample
16290
16291Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
16292@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
16293
16294@smallexample
16295(@value{GDBP})
16296*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
16297signal-meaning="Interrupt"
16298@end smallexample
16299
16300
16301@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
16302@findex -exec-abort
16303
16304@subsubheading Synopsis
16305
16306@smallexample
16307 -exec-abort
16308@end smallexample
16309
16310Kill the inferior running program.
16311
16312@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16313
16314The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
16315
16316@subsubheading Example
16317N.A.
16318
16319
16320@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
16321@findex -exec-arguments
16322
16323@subsubheading Synopsis
16324
16325@smallexample
16326 -exec-arguments @var{args}
16327@end smallexample
16328
16329Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
16330@samp{-exec-run}.
16331
16332@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16333
16334The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
16335
16336@subsubheading Example
16337
16338@c FIXME!
16339Don't have one around.
16340
16341
16342@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
16343@findex -exec-continue
16344
16345@subsubheading Synopsis
16346
16347@smallexample
16348 -exec-continue
16349@end smallexample
16350
16351Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16352until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
16353
16354@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16355
16356The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
16357
16358@subsubheading Example
16359
16360@smallexample
16361-exec-continue
16362^running
16363(@value{GDBP})
16364@@Hello world
16365*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
16366file="hello.c",line="13"@}
16367(@value{GDBP})
16368@end smallexample
16369
16370
16371@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
16372@findex -exec-finish
16373
16374@subsubheading Synopsis
16375
16376@smallexample
16377 -exec-finish
16378@end smallexample
16379
16380Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16381until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
16382the function.
16383
16384@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16385
16386The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
16387
16388@subsubheading Example
16389
16390Function returning @code{void}.
16391
16392@smallexample
16393-exec-finish
16394^running
16395(@value{GDBP})
16396@@hello from foo
16397*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16398file="hello.c",line="7"@}
16399(@value{GDBP})
16400@end smallexample
16401
16402Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
16403@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
16404value itself.
16405
16406@smallexample
16407-exec-finish
16408^running
16409(@value{GDBP})
16410*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
16411args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
16412file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16413gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
16414(@value{GDBP})
16415@end smallexample
16416
16417
16418@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16419@findex -exec-interrupt
16420
16421@subsubheading Synopsis
16422
16423@smallexample
16424 -exec-interrupt
16425@end smallexample
16426
16427Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16428Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16429execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16430itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16431interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16432
16433@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16434
16435The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16436
16437@subsubheading Example
16438
16439@smallexample
16440(@value{GDBP})
16441111-exec-continue
16442111^running
16443
16444(@value{GDBP})
16445222-exec-interrupt
16446222^done
16447(@value{GDBP})
16448111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16449frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16450(@value{GDBP})
16451
16452(@value{GDBP})
16453-exec-interrupt
16454^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16455(@value{GDBP})
16456@end smallexample
16457
16458
16459@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16460@findex -exec-next
16461
16462@subsubheading Synopsis
16463
16464@smallexample
16465 -exec-next
16466@end smallexample
16467
16468Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16469when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16470
16471@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16472
16473The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16474
16475@subsubheading Example
16476
16477@smallexample
16478-exec-next
16479^running
16480(@value{GDBP})
16481*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16482(@value{GDBP})
16483@end smallexample
16484
16485
16486@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16487@findex -exec-next-instruction
16488
16489@subsubheading Synopsis
16490
16491@smallexample
16492 -exec-next-instruction
16493@end smallexample
16494
16495Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16496instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16497the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16498address will be printed as well.
16499
16500@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16501
16502The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16503
16504@subsubheading Example
16505
16506@smallexample
16507(@value{GDBP})
16508-exec-next-instruction
16509^running
16510
16511(@value{GDBP})
16512*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16513addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16514(@value{GDBP})
16515@end smallexample
16516
16517
16518@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16519@findex -exec-return
16520
16521@subsubheading Synopsis
16522
16523@smallexample
16524 -exec-return
16525@end smallexample
16526
16527Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16528Displays the new current frame.
16529
16530@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16531
16532The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16533
16534@subsubheading Example
16535
16536@smallexample
16537(@value{GDBP})
16538200-break-insert callee4
16539200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16540file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16541(@value{GDBP})
16542000-exec-run
16543000^running
16544(@value{GDBP})
16545000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16546frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16547file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16548(@value{GDBP})
16549205-break-delete
16550205^done
16551(@value{GDBP})
16552111-exec-return
16553111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16554args=[@{name="strarg",
16555value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16556file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16557(@value{GDBP})
16558@end smallexample
16559
16560
16561@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16562@findex -exec-run
16563
16564@subsubheading Synopsis
16565
16566@smallexample
16567 -exec-run
16568@end smallexample
16569
16570Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16571beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16572encountered or the program exits.
16573
16574@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16575
16576The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16577
16578@subsubheading Example
16579
16580@smallexample
16581(@value{GDBP})
16582-break-insert main
16583^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16584(@value{GDBP})
16585-exec-run
16586^running
16587(@value{GDBP})
16588*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16589frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16590(@value{GDBP})
16591@end smallexample
16592
16593
16594@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16595@findex -exec-show-arguments
16596
16597@subsubheading Synopsis
16598
16599@smallexample
16600 -exec-show-arguments
16601@end smallexample
16602
16603Print the arguments of the program.
16604
16605@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16606
16607The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16608
16609@subsubheading Example
16610N.A.
16611
16612@c @subheading -exec-signal
16613
16614@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16615@findex -exec-step
16616
16617@subsubheading Synopsis
16618
16619@smallexample
16620 -exec-step
16621@end smallexample
16622
16623Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16624when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16625source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16626instruction of the called function.
16627
16628@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16629
16630The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16631
16632@subsubheading Example
16633
16634Stepping into a function:
16635
16636@smallexample
16637-exec-step
16638^running
16639(@value{GDBP})
16640*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16641frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16642@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16643(@value{GDBP})
16644@end smallexample
16645
16646Regular stepping:
16647
16648@smallexample
16649-exec-step
16650^running
16651(@value{GDBP})
16652*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16653(@value{GDBP})
16654@end smallexample
16655
16656
16657@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16658@findex -exec-step-instruction
16659
16660@subsubheading Synopsis
16661
16662@smallexample
16663 -exec-step-instruction
16664@end smallexample
16665
16666Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16667instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16668whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16669former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16670well.
16671
16672@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16673
16674The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16675
16676@subsubheading Example
16677
16678@smallexample
16679(@value{GDBP})
16680-exec-step-instruction
16681^running
16682
16683(@value{GDBP})
16684*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16685frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16686(@value{GDBP})
16687-exec-step-instruction
16688^running
16689
16690(@value{GDBP})
16691*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16692frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16693(@value{GDBP})
16694@end smallexample
16695
16696
16697@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16698@findex -exec-until
16699
16700@subsubheading Synopsis
16701
16702@smallexample
16703 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16704@end smallexample
16705
16706Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16707specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16708executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16709The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16710
16711@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16712
16713The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16714
16715@subsubheading Example
16716
16717@smallexample
16718(@value{GDBP})
16719-exec-until recursive2.c:6
16720^running
16721(@value{GDBP})
16722x = 55
16723*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16724file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16725(@value{GDBP})
16726@end smallexample
16727
16728@ignore
16729@subheading -file-clear
16730Is this going away????
16731@end ignore
16732
16733
16734@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16735@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16736
16737@subsubheading Synopsis
16738
16739@smallexample
16740 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16741@end smallexample
16742
16743Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16744which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16745command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16746are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16747error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16748notification.
16749
16750@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16751
16752The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16753
16754@subsubheading Example
16755
16756@smallexample
16757(@value{GDBP})
16758-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16759^done
16760(@value{GDBP})
16761@end smallexample
16762
16763
16764@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16765@findex -file-exec-file
16766
16767@subsubheading Synopsis
16768
16769@smallexample
16770 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16771@end smallexample
16772
16773Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16774@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16775from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16776about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16777notification.
16778
16779@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16780
16781The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16782
16783@subsubheading Example
16784
16785@smallexample
16786(@value{GDBP})
16787-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16788^done
16789(@value{GDBP})
16790@end smallexample
16791
16792
16793@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16794@findex -file-list-exec-sections
16795
16796@subsubheading Synopsis
16797
16798@smallexample
16799 -file-list-exec-sections
16800@end smallexample
16801
16802List the sections of the current executable file.
16803
16804@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16805
16806The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16807information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16808@samp{gdb_load_info}.
16809
16810@subsubheading Example
16811N.A.
16812
16813
1abaf70c
BR
16814@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16815@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16816
16817@subsubheading Synopsis
16818
16819@smallexample
16820 -file-list-exec-source-file
16821@end smallexample
16822
b383017d 16823List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
1abaf70c
BR
16824to the current source file for the current executable.
16825
16826@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16827
16828There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16829
16830@subsubheading Example
16831
16832@smallexample
16833(@value{GDBP})
16834123-file-list-exec-source-file
16835123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16836(@value{GDBP})
16837@end smallexample
16838
16839
922fbb7b
AC
16840@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16841@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16842
16843@subsubheading Synopsis
16844
16845@smallexample
16846 -file-list-exec-source-files
16847@end smallexample
16848
16849List the source files for the current executable.
16850
57c22c6c
BR
16851It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
16852file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
16853
922fbb7b
AC
16854@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16855
16856There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16857@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16858
16859@subsubheading Example
57c22c6c
BR
16860@smallexample
16861(@value{GDBP})
16862-file-list-exec-source-files
16863^done,files=[
16864@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
16865@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
16866@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
16867(@value{GDBP})
16868@end smallexample
922fbb7b
AC
16869
16870@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16871@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16872
16873@subsubheading Synopsis
16874
16875@smallexample
16876 -file-list-shared-libraries
16877@end smallexample
16878
16879List the shared libraries in the program.
16880
16881@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16882
16883The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16884
16885@subsubheading Example
16886N.A.
16887
16888
16889@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16890@findex -file-list-symbol-files
16891
16892@subsubheading Synopsis
16893
16894@smallexample
16895 -file-list-symbol-files
16896@end smallexample
16897
16898List symbol files.
16899
16900@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16901
16902The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16903
16904@subsubheading Example
16905N.A.
16906
16907
16908@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16909@findex -file-symbol-file
16910
16911@subsubheading Synopsis
16912
16913@smallexample
16914 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16915@end smallexample
16916
16917Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16918used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16919produced, except for a completion notification.
16920
16921@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16922
16923The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16924
16925@subsubheading Example
16926
16927@smallexample
16928(@value{GDBP})
16929-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16930^done
16931(@value{GDBP})
16932@end smallexample
16933
16934@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16935@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16936@section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16937
16938@c @subheading -gdb-complete
16939
16940@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16941@findex -gdb-exit
16942
16943@subsubheading Synopsis
16944
16945@smallexample
16946 -gdb-exit
16947@end smallexample
16948
16949Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16950
16951@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16952
16953Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16954
16955@subsubheading Example
16956
16957@smallexample
16958(@value{GDBP})
16959-gdb-exit
16960@end smallexample
16961
16962@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16963@findex -gdb-set
16964
16965@subsubheading Synopsis
16966
16967@smallexample
16968 -gdb-set
16969@end smallexample
16970
16971Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16972@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16973
16974@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16975
16976The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16977
16978@subsubheading Example
16979
16980@smallexample
16981(@value{GDBP})
16982-gdb-set $foo=3
16983^done
16984(@value{GDBP})
16985@end smallexample
16986
16987
16988@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16989@findex -gdb-show
16990
16991@subsubheading Synopsis
16992
16993@smallexample
16994 -gdb-show
16995@end smallexample
16996
16997Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16998
16999@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17000
17001The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
17002
17003@subsubheading Example
17004
17005@smallexample
17006(@value{GDBP})
17007-gdb-show annotate
17008^done,value="0"
17009(@value{GDBP})
17010@end smallexample
17011
17012@c @subheading -gdb-source
17013
17014
17015@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
17016@findex -gdb-version
17017
17018@subsubheading Synopsis
17019
17020@smallexample
17021 -gdb-version
17022@end smallexample
17023
17024Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
17025
17026@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17027
17028There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
17029information when you start an interactive session.
17030
17031@subsubheading Example
17032
17033@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
17034@c box in TeX.
17035@smallexample
17036(@value{GDBP})
17037-gdb-version
17038~GNU gdb 5.2.1
17039~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
17040~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
17041~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
17042~ certain conditions.
17043~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
17044~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
17045~ details.
b383017d 17046~This GDB was configured as
922fbb7b
AC
17047 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
17048^done
17049(@value{GDBP})
17050@end smallexample
17051
17052@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
17053@findex -interpreter-exec
17054
17055@subheading Synopsis
17056
17057@smallexample
17058-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
17059@end smallexample
17060
17061Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
17062
17063@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
17064
17065The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
17066
17067@subheading Example
17068
17069@smallexample
17070(@value{GDBP})
17071-interpreter-exec console "break main"
17072&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
17073&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
17074~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
17075^done
17076(@value{GDBP})
17077@end smallexample
17078
17079@ignore
17080@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17081@node GDB/MI Kod Commands
17082@section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
17083
17084The Kod commands are not implemented.
17085
17086@c @subheading -kod-info
17087
17088@c @subheading -kod-list
17089
17090@c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
17091
17092@c @subheading -kod-show
17093
17094@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17095@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
17096@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
17097
17098The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
17099
17100@c @subheading -overlay-auto
17101
17102@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
17103
17104@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
17105
17106@c @subheading -overlay-map
17107
17108@c @subheading -overlay-off
17109
17110@c @subheading -overlay-on
17111
17112@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
17113
17114@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17115@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
17116@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
17117
17118Signal handling commands are not implemented.
17119
17120@c @subheading -signal-handle
17121
17122@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
17123
17124@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
17125@end ignore
17126
17127
17128@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17129@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
17130@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
17131
17132
17133@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
17134@findex -stack-info-frame
17135
17136@subsubheading Synopsis
17137
17138@smallexample
17139 -stack-info-frame
17140@end smallexample
17141
17142Get info on the current frame.
17143
17144@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17145
17146The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
17147(without arguments).
17148
17149@subsubheading Example
17150N.A.
17151
17152@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
17153@findex -stack-info-depth
17154
17155@subsubheading Synopsis
17156
17157@smallexample
17158 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
17159@end smallexample
17160
17161Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
17162is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
17163
17164@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17165
17166There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17167
17168@subsubheading Example
17169
17170For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
17171
17172@smallexample
17173(@value{GDBP})
17174-stack-info-depth
17175^done,depth="12"
17176(@value{GDBP})
17177-stack-info-depth 4
17178^done,depth="4"
17179(@value{GDBP})
17180-stack-info-depth 12
17181^done,depth="12"
17182(@value{GDBP})
17183-stack-info-depth 11
17184^done,depth="11"
17185(@value{GDBP})
17186-stack-info-depth 13
17187^done,depth="12"
17188(@value{GDBP})
17189@end smallexample
17190
17191@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
17192@findex -stack-list-arguments
17193
17194@subsubheading Synopsis
17195
17196@smallexample
17197 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
17198 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17199@end smallexample
17200
17201Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
17202and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
17203@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
17204stack.
17205
17206The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
172070 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
17208means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
17209
17210@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17211
17212@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
17213@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
17214functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
17215
17216@subsubheading Example
17217
17218@smallexample
17219(@value{GDBP})
17220-stack-list-frames
17221^done,
17222stack=[
17223frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17224file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
17225frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
17226file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
17227frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
17228file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
17229frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
17230file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
17231frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
17232file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
17233(@value{GDBP})
17234-stack-list-arguments 0
17235^done,
17236stack-args=[
17237frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17238frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
17239frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
17240frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
17241frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17242(@value{GDBP})
17243-stack-list-arguments 1
17244^done,
17245stack-args=[
17246frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17247frame=@{level="1",
17248 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17249frame=@{level="2",args=[
17250@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17251@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17252@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
17253@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17254@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
17255@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
17256frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17257(@value{GDBP})
17258-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
17259^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
17260(@value{GDBP})
17261-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
17262^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
17263args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17264@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
17265(@value{GDBP})
17266@end smallexample
17267
17268@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
17269
17270
17271@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
17272@findex -stack-list-frames
17273
17274@subsubheading Synopsis
17275
17276@smallexample
17277 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17278@end smallexample
17279
17280List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
17281following info:
17282
17283@table @samp
17284@item @var{level}
17285The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
17286@item @var{addr}
17287The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
17288@item @var{func}
17289Function name.
17290@item @var{file}
17291File name of the source file where the function lives.
17292@item @var{line}
17293Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
17294@end table
17295
17296If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
17297whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
17298levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
17299are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
17300
17301@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17302
17303The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
17304
17305@subsubheading Example
17306
17307Full stack backtrace:
17308
17309@smallexample
17310(@value{GDBP})
17311-stack-list-frames
17312^done,stack=
17313[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
17314 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
17315frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17316 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17317frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17318 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17319frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17320 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17321frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17322 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17323frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17324 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17325frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17326 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17327frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17328 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17329frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17330 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17331frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17332 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17333frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17334 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17335frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
17336 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
17337(@value{GDBP})
17338@end smallexample
17339
17340Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
17341
17342@smallexample
17343(@value{GDBP})
17344-stack-list-frames 3 5
17345^done,stack=
17346[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17347 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17348frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17349 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17350frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17351 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17352(@value{GDBP})
17353@end smallexample
17354
17355Show a single frame:
17356
17357@smallexample
17358(@value{GDBP})
17359-stack-list-frames 3 3
17360^done,stack=
17361[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17362 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17363(@value{GDBP})
17364@end smallexample
17365
17366
17367@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
17368@findex -stack-list-locals
17369
17370@subsubheading Synopsis
17371
17372@smallexample
17373 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
17374@end smallexample
17375
17376Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
bc8ced35
NR
17377argument of 0 or @code{--no-values}, prints only the names of the variables.
17378With argument of 1 or @code{--all-values}, prints also their values. With
17379argument of 2 or @code{--simple-values}, prints the name, type and value for
17380simple data types and the name and type for arrays, structures and
17381unions. In this last case, the idea is that the user can see the
17382value of simple data types immediately and he can create variable
17383objects for other data types if he wishes to explore their values in
17384more detail.
922fbb7b
AC
17385
17386@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17387
17388@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
17389
17390@subsubheading Example
17391
17392@smallexample
17393(@value{GDBP})
17394-stack-list-locals 0
17395^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
17396(@value{GDBP})
bc8ced35 17397-stack-list-locals --all-values
922fbb7b 17398^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
bc8ced35
NR
17399 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
17400-stack-list-locals --simple-values
17401^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
17402 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
922fbb7b
AC
17403(@value{GDBP})
17404@end smallexample
17405
17406
17407@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
17408@findex -stack-select-frame
17409
17410@subsubheading Synopsis
17411
17412@smallexample
17413 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
17414@end smallexample
17415
17416Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
17417the stack.
17418
17419@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17420
17421The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
17422@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
17423
17424@subsubheading Example
17425
17426@smallexample
17427(@value{GDBP})
17428-stack-select-frame 2
17429^done
17430(@value{GDBP})
17431@end smallexample
17432
17433@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17434@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
17435@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
17436
17437
17438@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17439@findex -symbol-info-address
17440
17441@subsubheading Synopsis
17442
17443@smallexample
17444 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17445@end smallexample
17446
17447Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17448
17449@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17450
17451The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17452
17453@subsubheading Example
17454N.A.
17455
17456
17457@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17458@findex -symbol-info-file
17459
17460@subsubheading Synopsis
17461
17462@smallexample
17463 -symbol-info-file
17464@end smallexample
17465
17466Show the file for the symbol.
17467
17468@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17469
17470There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17471@samp{gdb_find_file}.
17472
17473@subsubheading Example
17474N.A.
17475
17476
17477@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17478@findex -symbol-info-function
17479
17480@subsubheading Synopsis
17481
17482@smallexample
17483 -symbol-info-function
17484@end smallexample
17485
17486Show which function the symbol lives in.
17487
17488@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17489
17490@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17491
17492@subsubheading Example
17493N.A.
17494
17495
17496@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17497@findex -symbol-info-line
17498
17499@subsubheading Synopsis
17500
17501@smallexample
17502 -symbol-info-line
17503@end smallexample
17504
17505Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17506
17507@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17508
71952f4c 17509The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
922fbb7b
AC
17510@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17511
17512@subsubheading Example
17513N.A.
17514
17515
17516@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17517@findex -symbol-info-symbol
17518
17519@subsubheading Synopsis
17520
17521@smallexample
17522 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17523@end smallexample
17524
17525Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17526
17527@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17528
17529The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17530
17531@subsubheading Example
17532N.A.
17533
17534
17535@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17536@findex -symbol-list-functions
17537
17538@subsubheading Synopsis
17539
17540@smallexample
17541 -symbol-list-functions
17542@end smallexample
17543
17544List the functions in the executable.
17545
17546@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17547
17548@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17549@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17550
17551@subsubheading Example
17552N.A.
17553
17554
32e7087d
JB
17555@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17556@findex -symbol-list-lines
17557
17558@subsubheading Synopsis
17559
17560@smallexample
17561 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17562@end smallexample
17563
17564Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17565addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17566ascending PC order.
17567
17568@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17569
17570There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17571
17572@subsubheading Example
17573@smallexample
17574(@value{GDBP})
17575-symbol-list-lines basics.c
54ff5908 17576^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32e7087d
JB
17577(@value{GDBP})
17578@end smallexample
17579
17580
922fbb7b
AC
17581@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17582@findex -symbol-list-types
17583
17584@subsubheading Synopsis
17585
17586@smallexample
17587 -symbol-list-types
17588@end smallexample
17589
17590List all the type names.
17591
17592@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17593
17594The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17595@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17596
17597@subsubheading Example
17598N.A.
17599
17600
17601@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17602@findex -symbol-list-variables
17603
17604@subsubheading Synopsis
17605
17606@smallexample
17607 -symbol-list-variables
17608@end smallexample
17609
17610List all the global and static variable names.
17611
17612@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17613
17614@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17615
17616@subsubheading Example
17617N.A.
17618
17619
17620@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17621@findex -symbol-locate
17622
17623@subsubheading Synopsis
17624
17625@smallexample
17626 -symbol-locate
17627@end smallexample
17628
17629@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17630
17631@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17632
17633@subsubheading Example
17634N.A.
17635
17636
17637@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17638@findex -symbol-type
17639
17640@subsubheading Synopsis
17641
17642@smallexample
17643 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17644@end smallexample
17645
17646Show type of @var{variable}.
17647
17648@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17649
17650The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17651@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17652
17653@subsubheading Example
17654N.A.
17655
17656
17657@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17658@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17659@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17660
17661
17662@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17663@findex -target-attach
17664
17665@subsubheading Synopsis
17666
17667@smallexample
17668 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17669@end smallexample
17670
17671Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17672
17673@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17674
17675The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17676
17677@subsubheading Example
17678N.A.
17679
17680
17681@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17682@findex -target-compare-sections
17683
17684@subsubheading Synopsis
17685
17686@smallexample
17687 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17688@end smallexample
17689
17690Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17691Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17692
17693@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17694
17695The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17696
17697@subsubheading Example
17698N.A.
17699
17700
17701@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17702@findex -target-detach
17703
17704@subsubheading Synopsis
17705
17706@smallexample
17707 -target-detach
17708@end smallexample
17709
17710Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17711
17712@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17713
17714The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17715
17716@subsubheading Example
17717
17718@smallexample
17719(@value{GDBP})
17720-target-detach
17721^done
17722(@value{GDBP})
17723@end smallexample
17724
17725
07f31aa6
DJ
17726@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
17727@findex -target-disconnect
17728
17729@subsubheading Synopsis
17730
17731@example
17732 -target-disconnect
17733@end example
17734
17735Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17736
17737@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17738
17739The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
17740
17741@subsubheading Example
17742
17743@smallexample
17744(@value{GDBP})
17745-target-disconnect
17746^done
17747(@value{GDBP})
17748@end smallexample
17749
17750
922fbb7b
AC
17751@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17752@findex -target-download
17753
17754@subsubheading Synopsis
17755
17756@smallexample
17757 -target-download
17758@end smallexample
17759
17760Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17761It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17762
17763@table @samp
17764@item section
17765The name of the section.
17766@item section-sent
17767The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17768@item section-size
17769The size of the section.
17770@item total-sent
17771The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17772@item total-size
17773The size of the overall executable to download.
17774@end table
17775
17776@noindent
17777Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17778@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17779
17780In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17781downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17782
17783@table @samp
17784@item section
17785The name of the section.
17786@item section-size
17787The size of the section.
17788@item total-size
17789The size of the overall executable to download.
17790@end table
17791
17792@noindent
17793At the end, a summary is printed.
17794
17795@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17796
17797The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17798
17799@subsubheading Example
17800
17801Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17802have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17803
17804@smallexample
17805(@value{GDBP})
17806-target-download
17807+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17808+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17809total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17810+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17811total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17812+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17813total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17814+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17815total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17816+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17817total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17818+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17819total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17820+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17821total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17822+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17823total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17824+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17825total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17826+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17827total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17828+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17829total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17830+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17831total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17832+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17833total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17834+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17835+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17836+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17837+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17838total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17839+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17840total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17841+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17842total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17843+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17844total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17845+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17846total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17847+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17848total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17849^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17850write-rate="429"
17851(@value{GDBP})
17852@end smallexample
17853
17854
17855@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17856@findex -target-exec-status
17857
17858@subsubheading Synopsis
17859
17860@smallexample
17861 -target-exec-status
17862@end smallexample
17863
17864Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17865not, for instance).
17866
17867@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17868
17869There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17870
17871@subsubheading Example
17872N.A.
17873
17874
17875@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17876@findex -target-list-available-targets
17877
17878@subsubheading Synopsis
17879
17880@smallexample
17881 -target-list-available-targets
17882@end smallexample
17883
17884List the possible targets to connect to.
17885
17886@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17887
17888The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17889
17890@subsubheading Example
17891N.A.
17892
17893
17894@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17895@findex -target-list-current-targets
17896
17897@subsubheading Synopsis
17898
17899@smallexample
17900 -target-list-current-targets
17901@end smallexample
17902
17903Describe the current target.
17904
17905@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17906
17907The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17908other things).
17909
17910@subsubheading Example
17911N.A.
17912
17913
17914@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17915@findex -target-list-parameters
17916
17917@subsubheading Synopsis
17918
17919@smallexample
17920 -target-list-parameters
17921@end smallexample
17922
17923@c ????
17924
17925@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17926
17927No equivalent.
17928
17929@subsubheading Example
17930N.A.
17931
17932
17933@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17934@findex -target-select
17935
17936@subsubheading Synopsis
17937
17938@smallexample
17939 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17940@end smallexample
17941
17942Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17943
17944@table @samp
17945@item @var{type}
17946The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17947@item @var{parameters}
17948Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17949Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17950@end table
17951
17952The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17953which the target program is, in the following form:
17954
17955@smallexample
17956^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17957 args=[@var{arg list}]
17958@end smallexample
17959
17960@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17961
17962The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17963
17964@subsubheading Example
17965
17966@smallexample
17967(@value{GDBP})
17968-target-select async /dev/ttya
17969^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17970(@value{GDBP})
17971@end smallexample
17972
17973@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17974@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17975@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17976
17977
17978@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17979@findex -thread-info
17980
17981@subsubheading Synopsis
17982
17983@smallexample
17984 -thread-info
17985@end smallexample
17986
17987@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17988
17989No equivalent.
17990
17991@subsubheading Example
17992N.A.
17993
17994
17995@subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17996@findex -thread-list-all-threads
17997
17998@subsubheading Synopsis
17999
18000@smallexample
18001 -thread-list-all-threads
18002@end smallexample
18003
18004@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18005
18006The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18007
18008@subsubheading Example
18009N.A.
18010
18011
18012@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18013@findex -thread-list-ids
18014
18015@subsubheading Synopsis
18016
18017@smallexample
18018 -thread-list-ids
18019@end smallexample
18020
18021Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18022end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18023
18024@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18025
18026Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18027
18028@subsubheading Example
18029
18030No threads present, besides the main process:
18031
18032@smallexample
18033(@value{GDBP})
18034-thread-list-ids
18035^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18036(@value{GDBP})
18037@end smallexample
18038
18039
18040Several threads:
18041
18042@smallexample
18043(@value{GDBP})
18044-thread-list-ids
18045^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18046number-of-threads="3"
18047(@value{GDBP})
18048@end smallexample
18049
18050
18051@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18052@findex -thread-select
18053
18054@subsubheading Synopsis
18055
18056@smallexample
18057 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18058@end smallexample
18059
18060Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18061current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18062
18063@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18064
18065The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18066
18067@subsubheading Example
18068
18069@smallexample
18070(@value{GDBP})
18071-exec-next
18072^running
18073(@value{GDBP})
18074*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18075file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18076(@value{GDBP})
18077-thread-list-ids
18078^done,
18079thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18080number-of-threads="3"
18081(@value{GDBP})
18082-thread-select 3
18083^done,new-thread-id="3",
18084frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18085args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18086@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18087(@value{GDBP})
18088@end smallexample
18089
18090@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18091@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
18092@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
18093
18094The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
18095
18096@c @subheading -trace-actions
18097
18098@c @subheading -trace-delete
18099
18100@c @subheading -trace-disable
18101
18102@c @subheading -trace-dump
18103
18104@c @subheading -trace-enable
18105
18106@c @subheading -trace-exists
18107
18108@c @subheading -trace-find
18109
18110@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
18111
18112@c @subheading -trace-info
18113
18114@c @subheading -trace-insert
18115
18116@c @subheading -trace-list
18117
18118@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
18119
18120@c @subheading -trace-save
18121
18122@c @subheading -trace-start
18123
18124@c @subheading -trace-stop
18125
18126
18127@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18128@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
18129@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
18130
18131
18132@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
18133
18134For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
18135expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
18136used by @code{Insight}.
18137
18138The two main reasons for that are:
18139
18140@enumerate 1
18141@item
18142It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
18143
18144@item
18145It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
18146now).
18147@end enumerate
18148
18149The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
18150slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
18151describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
18152hints about their use.
18153
18154@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
18155expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
18156least, the following operations:
18157
18158@itemize @bullet
18159@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
18160@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
18161@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
18162@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
18163@end itemize
18164
18165@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
18166
18167@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
18168The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
18169to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
18170register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
18171examining or changing its properties.
18172
18173Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
18174in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
18175root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
18176is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
18177Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
18178
18179When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
18180for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
18181creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
18182and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
18183chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
18184for pointers, etc.).
18185
18186The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
18187access this functionality:
18188
18189@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
18190@item @strong{Operation}
18191@tab @strong{Description}
18192
18193@item @code{-var-create}
18194@tab create a variable object
18195@item @code{-var-delete}
18196@tab delete the variable object and its children
18197@item @code{-var-set-format}
18198@tab set the display format of this variable
18199@item @code{-var-show-format}
18200@tab show the display format of this variable
18201@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
18202@tab tells how many children this object has
18203@item @code{-var-list-children}
18204@tab return a list of the object's children
18205@item @code{-var-info-type}
18206@tab show the type of this variable object
18207@item @code{-var-info-expression}
18208@tab print what this variable object represents
18209@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
18210@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
18211@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
18212@tab get the value of this variable
18213@item @code{-var-assign}
18214@tab set the value of this variable
18215@item @code{-var-update}
18216@tab update the variable and its children
18217@end multitable
18218
18219In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
18220how it can be used.
18221
18222@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
18223
18224@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
18225@findex -var-create
18226
18227@subsubheading Synopsis
18228
18229@smallexample
18230 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
18231 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
18232@end smallexample
18233
18234This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
18235a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
18236register.
18237
18238The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
18239referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
18240system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
18241unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
18242The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
18243
18244The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
18245specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
18246frame should be used.
18247
18248@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
18249begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
18250
18251@itemize @bullet
18252@item
18253@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
18254
18255@item
18256@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
18257
18258@item
18259@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
18260@end itemize
18261
18262@subsubheading Result
18263
18264This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
18265object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
18266the @value{GDBN} CLI:
18267
18268@smallexample
18269 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
18270@end smallexample
18271
18272
18273@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
18274@findex -var-delete
18275
18276@subsubheading Synopsis
18277
18278@smallexample
18279 -var-delete @var{name}
18280@end smallexample
18281
18282Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
18283
18284Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
18285
18286
18287@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
18288@findex -var-set-format
18289
18290@subsubheading Synopsis
18291
18292@smallexample
18293 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
18294@end smallexample
18295
18296Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
18297@var{format-spec}.
18298
18299The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
18300
18301@smallexample
18302 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
18303 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
18304@end smallexample
18305
18306
18307@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
18308@findex -var-show-format
18309
18310@subsubheading Synopsis
18311
18312@smallexample
18313 -var-show-format @var{name}
18314@end smallexample
18315
18316Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
18317
18318@smallexample
18319 @var{format} @expansion{}
18320 @var{format-spec}
18321@end smallexample
18322
18323
18324@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
18325@findex -var-info-num-children
18326
18327@subsubheading Synopsis
18328
18329@smallexample
18330 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
18331@end smallexample
18332
18333Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
18334
18335@smallexample
18336 numchild=@var{n}
18337@end smallexample
18338
18339
18340@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
18341@findex -var-list-children
18342
18343@subsubheading Synopsis
18344
18345@smallexample
bc8ced35 18346 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
922fbb7b
AC
18347@end smallexample
18348
bc8ced35
NR
18349Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object. With
18350just the variable object name as an argument or with an optional
18351preceding argument of 0 or @code{--no-values}, prints only the names of the
18352variables. With an optional preceding argument of 1 or @code{--all-values},
18353also prints their values.
18354
18355@subsubheading Example
922fbb7b
AC
18356
18357@smallexample
bc8ced35
NR
18358(@value{GDBP})
18359 -var-list-children n
922fbb7b
AC
18360 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18361 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
bc8ced35
NR
18362(@value{GDBP})
18363 -var-list-children --all-values n
18364 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18365 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
922fbb7b
AC
18366@end smallexample
18367
18368
18369@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
18370@findex -var-info-type
18371
18372@subsubheading Synopsis
18373
18374@smallexample
18375 -var-info-type @var{name}
18376@end smallexample
18377
18378Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
18379returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
18380@value{GDBN} CLI:
18381
18382@smallexample
18383 type=@var{typename}
18384@end smallexample
18385
18386
18387@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
18388@findex -var-info-expression
18389
18390@subsubheading Synopsis
18391
18392@smallexample
18393 -var-info-expression @var{name}
18394@end smallexample
18395
18396Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
18397
18398@smallexample
18399 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
18400@end smallexample
18401
18402@noindent
18403where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
18404
18405@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
18406@findex -var-show-attributes
18407
18408@subsubheading Synopsis
18409
18410@smallexample
18411 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
18412@end smallexample
18413
18414List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
18415
18416@smallexample
18417 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
18418@end smallexample
18419
18420@noindent
18421where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
18422
18423@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
18424@findex -var-evaluate-expression
18425
18426@subsubheading Synopsis
18427
18428@smallexample
18429 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
18430@end smallexample
18431
18432Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
18433object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
18434for the object:
18435
18436@smallexample
18437 value=@var{value}
18438@end smallexample
18439
18440Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
18441before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
18442
18443@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
18444@findex -var-assign
18445
18446@subsubheading Synopsis
18447
18448@smallexample
18449 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
18450@end smallexample
18451
18452Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
18453by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
b383017d 18454value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
922fbb7b
AC
18455subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
18456
18457@subsubheading Example
18458
18459@smallexample
18460(@value{GDBP})
18461-var-assign var1 3
18462^done,value="3"
18463(@value{GDBP})
18464-var-update *
18465^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
18466(@value{GDBP})
18467@end smallexample
18468
18469@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
18470@findex -var-update
18471
18472@subsubheading Synopsis
18473
18474@smallexample
18475 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18476@end smallexample
18477
18478Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18479expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18480A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18481
18482
18483@node Annotations
18484@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18485
086432e2
AC
18486This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
18487designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
18488similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
922fbb7b
AC
18489relatively high level.
18490
086432e2
AC
18491The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
18492(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
18493
922fbb7b
AC
18494@ignore
18495This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18496@end ignore
18497
18498@menu
18499* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18500* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
922fbb7b
AC
18501* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18502* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
922fbb7b
AC
18503* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18504* Annotations for Running::
18505 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18506* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
922fbb7b
AC
18507@end menu
18508
18509@node Annotations Overview
18510@section What is an Annotation?
18511@cindex annotations
18512
922fbb7b
AC
18513Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18514characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18515information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18516is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18517information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18518additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18519cannot contain newline characters.
18520
18521Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18522characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18523no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18524@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18525annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18526means those three characters as output.
18527
086432e2
AC
18528The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
18529@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
18530how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
18531values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
18532is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
18533subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
18534for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
18535been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
18536Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). This chapter
18537describes level 3 annotations.
18538
922fbb7b
AC
18539A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18540
18541@smallexample
086432e2
AC
18542$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
18543GNU gdb 6.0
18544Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
922fbb7b
AC
18545GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18546and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18547under certain conditions.
18548Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18549There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18550for details.
086432e2 18551This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
922fbb7b
AC
18552
18553^Z^Zpre-prompt
b383017d 18554(gdb)
922fbb7b 18555^Z^Zprompt
086432e2 18556@kbd{quit}
922fbb7b
AC
18557
18558^Z^Zpost-prompt
b383017d 18559$
922fbb7b
AC
18560@end smallexample
18561
18562Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18563@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18564denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18565output from @value{GDBN}.
18566
18567@node Server Prefix
18568@section The Server Prefix
18569@cindex server prefix for annotations
18570
18571To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18572the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18573means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18574affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18575pressed on a line by itself.
18576
18577The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18578history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18579use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18580
922fbb7b
AC
18581@node Prompting
18582@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18583
18584@cindex annotations for prompts
18585When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18586to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18587over, etc.
18588
18589Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18590input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18591denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18592annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18593annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18594associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18595features the following annotations:
18596
18597@smallexample
18598^Z^Zpre-prompt
18599^Z^Zprompt
18600^Z^Zpost-prompt
18601@end smallexample
18602
18603The input types are
18604
18605@table @code
18606@findex pre-prompt
18607@findex prompt
18608@findex post-prompt
18609@item prompt
18610When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18611
18612@findex pre-commands
18613@findex commands
18614@findex post-commands
18615@item commands
18616When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18617command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18618
18619@findex pre-overload-choice
18620@findex overload-choice
18621@findex post-overload-choice
18622@item overload-choice
18623When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18624
18625@findex pre-query
18626@findex query
18627@findex post-query
18628@item query
18629When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18630
18631@findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18632@findex prompt-for-continue
18633@findex post-prompt-for-continue
18634@item prompt-for-continue
18635When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18636expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18637prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18638presence of annotations.
18639@end table
18640
18641@node Errors
18642@section Errors
18643@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18644
18645@findex quit
18646@smallexample
18647^Z^Zquit
18648@end smallexample
18649
18650This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18651
18652@findex error
18653@smallexample
18654^Z^Zerror
18655@end smallexample
18656
18657This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18658
18659Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18660in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18661@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18662cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18663cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18664does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18665to the top level.
18666
18667@findex error-begin
18668A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18669
18670@smallexample
18671^Z^Zerror-begin
18672@end smallexample
18673
18674Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18675message.
18676
18677Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18678@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18679@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18680
922fbb7b
AC
18681@node Invalidation
18682@section Invalidation Notices
18683
18684@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18685The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18686changed.
18687
18688@table @code
18689@findex frames-invalid
18690@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18691
18692The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18693have changed.
18694
18695@findex breakpoints-invalid
18696@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18697
18698The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18699deleted a breakpoint.
18700@end table
18701
18702@node Annotations for Running
18703@section Running the Program
18704@cindex annotations for running programs
18705
18706@findex starting
18707@findex stopping
18708When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
b383017d 18709@code{step} or @code{continue},
922fbb7b
AC
18710
18711@smallexample
18712^Z^Zstarting
18713@end smallexample
18714
b383017d 18715is output. When the program stops,
922fbb7b
AC
18716
18717@smallexample
18718^Z^Zstopped
18719@end smallexample
18720
18721is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18722annotations describe how the program stopped.
18723
18724@table @code
18725@findex exited
18726@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18727The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18728successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18729
18730@findex signalled
18731@findex signal-name
18732@findex signal-name-end
18733@findex signal-string
18734@findex signal-string-end
18735@item ^Z^Zsignalled
18736The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18737annotation continues:
18738
18739@smallexample
18740@var{intro-text}
18741^Z^Zsignal-name
18742@var{name}
18743^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18744@var{middle-text}
18745^Z^Zsignal-string
18746@var{string}
18747^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18748@var{end-text}
18749@end smallexample
18750
18751@noindent
18752where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18753@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18754as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18755@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18756user's benefit and have no particular format.
18757
18758@findex signal
18759@item ^Z^Zsignal
18760The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18761just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18762terminated with it.
18763
18764@findex breakpoint
18765@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18766The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18767
18768@findex watchpoint
18769@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18770The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18771@end table
18772
18773@node Source Annotations
18774@section Displaying Source
18775@cindex annotations for source display
18776
18777@findex source
18778The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18779
18780@smallexample
18781^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18782@end smallexample
18783
18784where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18785file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18786first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18787within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18788debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18789@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18790line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18791@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18792source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18793followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18794depend on the language).
18795
8e04817f
AC
18796@node GDB Bugs
18797@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18798@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18799@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 18800
8e04817f 18801Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 18802
8e04817f
AC
18803Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18804may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18805the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18806reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 18807
8e04817f
AC
18808In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18809information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
18810
18811@menu
8e04817f
AC
18812* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18813* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
18814@end menu
18815
8e04817f
AC
18816@node Bug Criteria
18817@section Have you found a bug?
18818@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 18819
8e04817f 18820If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
18821
18822@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
18823@cindex fatal signal
18824@cindex debugger crash
18825@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 18826@item
8e04817f
AC
18827If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18828@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18829
18830@cindex error on valid input
18831@item
18832If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18833bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18834somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 18835
8e04817f 18836@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 18837@item
8e04817f
AC
18838If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18839that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18840``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18841for traditional practice''.
18842
18843@item
18844If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18845for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
18846@end itemize
18847
8e04817f
AC
18848@node Bug Reporting
18849@section How to report bugs
18850@cindex bug reports
18851@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18852
18853A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18854If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18855contact that organization first.
18856
18857You can find contact information for many support companies and
18858individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18859distribution.
18860@c should add a web page ref...
18861
129188f6
AC
18862In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18863@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18864@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18865page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18866be used.
8e04817f
AC
18867
18868@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18869@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18870not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18871@samp{bug-gdb}.
18872
18873The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18874serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18875the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18876newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18877problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18878path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18879we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18880bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 18881
8e04817f
AC
18882The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18883@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18884fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 18885
8e04817f
AC
18886Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18887problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18888assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18889Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18890stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18891name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18892of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18893the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18894easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 18895
8e04817f
AC
18896Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18897bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18898you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18899self-contained.
c4555f82 18900
8e04817f
AC
18901Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18902bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18903@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18904bugs properly.
18905
18906To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
18907
18908@itemize @bullet
18909@item
8e04817f
AC
18910The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18911with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18912version}.
c4555f82 18913
8e04817f
AC
18914Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18915the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
18916
18917@item
8e04817f
AC
18918The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18919version number.
c4555f82
SC
18920
18921@item
8e04817f
AC
18922What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18923``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
18924
18925@item
8e04817f
AC
18926What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18927debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18928C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18929information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18930compilers.
c4555f82 18931
8e04817f
AC
18932@item
18933The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18934observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18935you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18936Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 18937
8e04817f
AC
18938If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18939and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 18940
8e04817f
AC
18941@item
18942A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18943reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 18944
8e04817f
AC
18945@item
18946A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18947incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 18948
8e04817f
AC
18949Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18950will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18951not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18952a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 18953
8e04817f
AC
18954Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18955say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18956copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18957the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18958crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18959ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18960us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18961to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 18962
e0c07bf0
MC
18963@pindex script
18964@cindex recording a session script
18965To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
18966such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
18967Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
18968include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
18969
18970Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
18971inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
18972
8e04817f
AC
18973@item
18974If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18975diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18976it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 18977
8e04817f
AC
18978The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18979sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 18980
8e04817f 18981@end itemize
c4555f82 18982
8e04817f 18983Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 18984
8e04817f
AC
18985@itemize @bullet
18986@item
18987A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 18988
8e04817f
AC
18989Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18990which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18991changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 18992
8e04817f
AC
18993This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18994will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18995with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18996We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 18997
8e04817f
AC
18998Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18999of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
19000output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
19001less time, and so on.
c4555f82 19002
8e04817f
AC
19003However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
19004report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 19005
8e04817f
AC
19006@item
19007A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 19008
8e04817f
AC
19009A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
19010the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
19011a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
19012to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 19013
8e04817f
AC
19014Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
19015construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
19016through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
19017to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 19018
8e04817f
AC
19019And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
19020patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
19021help us to understand.
c4555f82 19022
8e04817f
AC
19023@item
19024A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 19025
8e04817f
AC
19026Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
19027things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
19028@end itemize
c4555f82 19029
8e04817f
AC
19030@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
19031@c and consists of the two following files:
19032@c rluser.texinfo
19033@c inc-hist.texinfo
19034@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
19035@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
19036@include rluser.texinfo
19037@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 19038
c4555f82 19039
8e04817f
AC
19040@node Formatting Documentation
19041@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 19042
8e04817f
AC
19043@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
19044@cindex reference card
19045The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
19046for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
19047subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
19048@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
19049release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
19050you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 19051
8e04817f
AC
19052The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
19053can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 19054
474c8240 19055@smallexample
8e04817f 19056make refcard.dvi
474c8240 19057@end smallexample
c4555f82 19058
8e04817f
AC
19059The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
19060mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
19061that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
19062high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
19063your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 19064
8e04817f 19065@cindex documentation
c4555f82 19066
8e04817f
AC
19067All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
19068distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
19069a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
19070on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
19071formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
19072and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 19073
8e04817f
AC
19074@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
19075version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
19076file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
19077subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
19078necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
19079but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
19080Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
19081@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 19082
8e04817f
AC
19083If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
19084Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
19085@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 19086
8e04817f
AC
19087If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
19088@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
19089version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 19090
474c8240 19091@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19092cd gdb
19093make gdb.info
474c8240 19094@end smallexample
c4555f82 19095
8e04817f
AC
19096If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
19097a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
19098Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 19099
8e04817f
AC
19100@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
19101produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
19102document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
19103has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
19104command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
19105(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
19106require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 19107
8e04817f
AC
19108@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
19109@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
19110written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
19111typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
19112and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
19113directory.
c4555f82 19114
8e04817f
AC
19115If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
19116typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
19117subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
19118@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 19119
474c8240 19120@smallexample
8e04817f 19121make gdb.dvi
474c8240 19122@end smallexample
c4555f82 19123
8e04817f 19124Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 19125
8e04817f
AC
19126@node Installing GDB
19127@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
19128@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
19129@cindex installation
94e91d6d 19130@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
c4555f82 19131
8e04817f
AC
19132@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
19133of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
19134build the @code{gdb} program.
19135@iftex
19136@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
19137@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
19138look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
19139installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
19140@end iftex
c4555f82 19141
8e04817f
AC
19142The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
19143@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
19144appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 19145
8e04817f
AC
19146For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
19147@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 19148
8e04817f
AC
19149@table @code
19150@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
19151script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 19152
8e04817f
AC
19153@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
19154the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 19155
8e04817f
AC
19156@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
19157source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 19158
8e04817f
AC
19159@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
19160@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 19161
8e04817f
AC
19162@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
19163source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 19164
8e04817f
AC
19165@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
19166source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 19167
8e04817f
AC
19168@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
19169source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 19170
8e04817f
AC
19171@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
19172source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 19173
8e04817f
AC
19174@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
19175source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
19176@end table
c906108c 19177
8e04817f
AC
19178The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
19179from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
19180this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 19181
8e04817f
AC
19182First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
19183if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
19184identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
19185argument.
c906108c 19186
8e04817f 19187For example:
c906108c 19188
474c8240 19189@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19190cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19191./configure @var{host}
19192make
474c8240 19193@end smallexample
c906108c 19194
8e04817f
AC
19195@noindent
19196where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
19197@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
19198(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
19199correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 19200
8e04817f
AC
19201Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
19202@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
19203libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
19204binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 19205
8e04817f
AC
19206@need 750
19207@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
19208system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
19209shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 19210
474c8240 19211@smallexample
8e04817f 19212sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 19213@end smallexample
c906108c 19214
8e04817f
AC
19215If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
19216directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
19217@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
19218creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
19219you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
19220
94e91d6d
MC
19221You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
19222source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
19223@code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
19224that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
19225if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
19226of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
19227configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
19228directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
19229about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
c906108c 19230
8e04817f
AC
19231You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
19232However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
19233the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
19234that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
19235let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 19236
8e04817f
AC
19237@menu
19238* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19239* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
19240* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
19241@end menu
c906108c 19242
8e04817f
AC
19243@node Separate Objdir
19244@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 19245
8e04817f
AC
19246If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
19247you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
19248host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
19249allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19250rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19251handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19252@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19253program specified there.
c906108c 19254
8e04817f
AC
19255To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19256with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19257(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19258itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19259would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19260the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 19261
8e04817f
AC
19262For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19263separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 19264
474c8240 19265@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19266@group
19267cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19268mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19269cd ../gdb-sun4
19270../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19271make
19272@end group
474c8240 19273@end smallexample
c906108c 19274
8e04817f
AC
19275When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19276directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19277(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19278the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19279directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19280@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 19281
94e91d6d
MC
19282Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19283instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19284like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19285one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19286build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19287
8e04817f
AC
19288One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19289directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19290@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19291programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19292You specify a cross-debugging target by
19293giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 19294
8e04817f
AC
19295When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19296it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19297called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 19298
8e04817f
AC
19299The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19300directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19301directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19302directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19303will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 19304
8e04817f
AC
19305When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19306directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19307if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19308with each other.
c906108c 19309
8e04817f
AC
19310@node Config Names
19311@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 19312
8e04817f
AC
19313The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19314script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19315aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19316of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 19317
474c8240 19318@smallexample
8e04817f 19319@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 19320@end smallexample
c906108c 19321
8e04817f
AC
19322For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19323or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19324option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 19325
8e04817f
AC
19326The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19327any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19328aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19329@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19330script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19331abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 19332
8e04817f
AC
19333@smallexample
19334% sh config.sub i386-linux
19335i386-pc-linux-gnu
19336% sh config.sub alpha-linux
19337alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19338% sh config.sub hp9k700
19339hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19340% sh config.sub sun4
19341sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19342% sh config.sub sun3
19343m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19344% sh config.sub i986v
19345Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19346@end smallexample
c906108c 19347
8e04817f
AC
19348@noindent
19349@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19350directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 19351
8e04817f
AC
19352@node Configure Options
19353@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 19354
8e04817f
AC
19355Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19356are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19357several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19358Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 19359
474c8240 19360@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19361configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19362 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19363 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19364 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19365 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19366 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19367 @var{host}
474c8240 19368@end smallexample
c906108c 19369
8e04817f
AC
19370@noindent
19371You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19372@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19373@samp{--}.
c906108c 19374
8e04817f
AC
19375@table @code
19376@item --help
19377Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 19378
8e04817f
AC
19379@item --prefix=@var{dir}
19380Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19381@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19382
8e04817f
AC
19383@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19384Configure the source to install programs under directory
19385@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19386
8e04817f
AC
19387@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19388@need 2000
19389@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19390@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19391@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19392Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19393@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19394build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19395directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19396the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19397directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19398the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19399@var{dirname}.
c906108c 19400
8e04817f
AC
19401@item --norecursion
19402Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19403propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 19404
8e04817f
AC
19405@item --target=@var{target}
19406Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19407@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19408programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 19409
8e04817f 19410There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 19411
8e04817f
AC
19412@item @var{host} @dots{}
19413Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 19414
8e04817f
AC
19415There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19416@end table
c906108c 19417
8e04817f
AC
19418There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19419needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 19420
8e04817f
AC
19421@node Maintenance Commands
19422@appendix Maintenance Commands
19423@cindex maintenance commands
19424@cindex internal commands
c906108c 19425
8e04817f
AC
19426In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19427includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19428These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 19429
8e04817f
AC
19430@table @code
19431@kindex maint info breakpoints
19432@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19433Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19434breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19435internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19436breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19437is shown:
c906108c 19438
8e04817f
AC
19439@table @code
19440@item breakpoint
19441Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 19442
8e04817f
AC
19443@item watchpoint
19444Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 19445
8e04817f
AC
19446@item longjmp
19447Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19448@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 19449
8e04817f
AC
19450@item longjmp resume
19451Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 19452
8e04817f
AC
19453@item until
19454Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 19455
8e04817f
AC
19456@item finish
19457Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 19458
8e04817f
AC
19459@item shlib events
19460Shared library events.
c906108c 19461
8e04817f 19462@end table
c906108c 19463
8d30a00d
AC
19464@kindex maint internal-error
19465@kindex maint internal-warning
19466@item maint internal-error
19467@itemx maint internal-warning
19468Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19469or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19470or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19471internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19472either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19473@value{GDBN} session.
19474
19475@smallexample
19476(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19477@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19478A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19479debugging may prove unreliable.
19480Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19481Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
b383017d 19482(gdb)
8d30a00d
AC
19483@end smallexample
19484
19485Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19486warning message.
19487
00905d52
AC
19488@kindex maint print dummy-frames
19489@item maint print dummy-frames
19490
19491Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19492
19493@smallexample
19494(gdb) @kbd{b add}
19495@dots{}
19496(gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19497Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
1949858 return (a + b);
19499The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19500@dots{}
19501(gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
195020x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19503 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19504 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
b383017d 19505(gdb)
00905d52
AC
19506@end smallexample
19507
19508Takes an optional file parameter.
19509
0680b120
AC
19510@kindex maint print registers
19511@kindex maint print raw-registers
19512@kindex maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19513@kindex maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19514@item maint print registers
19515@itemx maint print raw-registers
19516@itemx maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19517@itemx maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19518Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19519
617073a9
AC
19520The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19521the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19522includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19523@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19524register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19525@value{GDBN} Internals}.
0680b120
AC
19526
19527Takes an optional file parameter.
19528
617073a9
AC
19529@kindex maint print reggroups
19530@item maint print reggroups
19531Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19532
19533Takes an optional file parameter.
19534
19535@smallexample
19536(gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
b383017d
RM
19537 Group Type
19538 general user
19539 float user
19540 all user
19541 vector user
19542 system user
19543 save internal
19544 restore internal
617073a9
AC
19545@end smallexample
19546
e7ba9c65
DJ
19547@kindex maint set profile
19548@kindex maint show profile
19549@cindex profiling GDB
19550@item maint set profile
19551@itemx maint show profile
19552Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19553
19554Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19555command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19556collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19557exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19558if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19559(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19560data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19561
19562Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
b383017d 19563compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
e7ba9c65 19564
8e04817f 19565@end table
c906108c 19566
c906108c 19567
e0ce93ac 19568@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 19569@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 19570
ee2d5c50
AC
19571@menu
19572* Overview::
19573* Packets::
19574* Stop Reply Packets::
19575* General Query Packets::
19576* Register Packet Format::
19577* Examples::
0ce1b118 19578* File-I/O remote protocol extension::
ee2d5c50
AC
19579@end menu
19580
19581@node Overview
19582@section Overview
19583
8e04817f
AC
19584There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19585protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19586machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19587recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 19588
d2c6833e 19589In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 19590transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 19591
8e04817f
AC
19592@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19593@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19594@cindex remote serial protocol
19595All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19596sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19597@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19598@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 19599
474c8240 19600@smallexample
8e04817f 19601@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19602@end smallexample
8e04817f 19603@noindent
c906108c 19604
8e04817f
AC
19605@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19606@noindent
19607The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19608characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19609eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 19610
8e04817f
AC
19611Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19612specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 19613
474c8240 19614@smallexample
8e04817f 19615@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19616@end smallexample
c906108c 19617
8e04817f
AC
19618@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19619@noindent
19620That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19621has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19622since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 19623
8e04817f
AC
19624@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19625When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19626response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19627the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19628retransmission):
c906108c 19629
474c8240 19630@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
19631-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19632<- @code{+}
474c8240 19633@end smallexample
8e04817f 19634@noindent
53a5351d 19635
8e04817f
AC
19636The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19637debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19638the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19639when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 19640
8e04817f
AC
19641@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19642exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19643exceptions).
c906108c 19644
8e04817f 19645Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 19646@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 19647@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 19648@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 19649
8e04817f
AC
19650Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19651@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19652would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 19653
8e04817f
AC
19654Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19655means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19656which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19657@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19658where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19659characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19660value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 19661
8e04817f 19662So:
474c8240 19663@smallexample
8e04817f 19664"@code{0* }"
474c8240 19665@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19666@noindent
19667means the same as "0000".
c906108c 19668
8e04817f
AC
19669The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19670error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 19671
8e04817f
AC
19672For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19673(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19674protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19675on that response.
c906108c 19676
b383017d
RM
19677A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19678@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
8e04817f 19679optional.
c906108c 19680
ee2d5c50
AC
19681@node Packets
19682@section Packets
19683
19684The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19685@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19686
19687@table @r
19688
19689@item @code{!} --- extended mode
19690@cindex @code{!} packet
19691
8e04817f
AC
19692Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19693persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19694debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
19695
19696Reply:
19697@table @samp
19698@item OK
8e04817f 19699The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 19700@end table
c906108c 19701
ee2d5c50
AC
19702@item @code{?} --- last signal
19703@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 19704
ee2d5c50
AC
19705Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19706step and continue.
c906108c 19707
ee2d5c50
AC
19708Reply:
19709@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19710
19711@item @code{a} --- reserved
19712
19713Reserved for future use.
19714
19715@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19716@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 19717
8e04817f
AC
19718Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19719specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19720See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19721
19722Reply:
19723@table @samp
19724@item OK
19725@item E@var{NN}
19726@end table
19727
19728@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19729@cindex @code{b} packet
19730
19731Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19732
19733JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19734received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19735problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19736
19737Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19738it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19739some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19740switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19741of view, nothing actually happened.}
19742
19743@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19744@cindex @code{B} packet
19745
8e04817f 19746Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
19747breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19748
19749This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19750(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 19751
ee2d5c50
AC
19752@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19753@cindex @code{c} packet
19754
19755@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 19756current address.
c906108c 19757
ee2d5c50
AC
19758Reply:
19759@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19760
19761@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19762@cindex @code{C} packet
19763
8e04817f
AC
19764Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19765@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 19766
ee2d5c50
AC
19767Reply:
19768@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 19769
ee2d5c50
AC
19770@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19771@cindex @code{d} packet
19772
19773Toggle debug flag.
19774
19775@item @code{D} --- detach
19776@cindex @code{D} packet
19777
19778Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
07f31aa6 19779before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
ee2d5c50
AC
19780
19781Reply:
19782@table @samp
19783@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 19784@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 19785@end table
c906108c 19786
ee2d5c50 19787@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 19788
ee2d5c50 19789Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19790
ee2d5c50 19791@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 19792
ee2d5c50 19793Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19794
ee2d5c50
AC
19795@item @code{f} --- reserved
19796
19797Reserved for future use.
19798
0ce1b118
CV
19799@item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19800@cindex @code{F} packet
ee2d5c50 19801
0ce1b118
CV
19802This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19803sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19804@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
ee2d5c50
AC
19805
19806@item @code{g} --- read registers
19807@anchor{read registers packet}
19808@cindex @code{g} packet
19809
19810Read general registers.
19811
19812Reply:
19813@table @samp
19814@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
19815Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19816with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19817each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
12c266ea
AC
19818determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
19819@var{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
19820specification of several standard @code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
19821@item E@var{NN}
19822for an error.
19823@end table
c906108c 19824
ee2d5c50
AC
19825@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19826@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 19827
ee2d5c50
AC
19828@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19829data.
19830
19831Reply:
19832@table @samp
19833@item OK
19834for success
19835@item E@var{NN}
19836for an error
19837@end table
19838
19839@item @code{h} --- reserved
19840
19841Reserved for future use.
19842
b383017d 19843@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
ee2d5c50 19844@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 19845
8e04817f 19846Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
19847@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19848should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19849operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19850the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19851
19852Reply:
19853@table @samp
19854@item OK
19855for success
19856@item E@var{NN}
19857for an error
19858@end table
c906108c 19859
8e04817f
AC
19860@c FIXME: JTC:
19861@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19862@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19863@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19864@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19865@c described. For example:
19866@c
19867@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19868@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19869@c otherwise returns current registers.
19870@c
19871@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19872@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19873@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 19874
ee2d5c50
AC
19875@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19876@anchor{cycle step packet}
19877@cindex @code{i} packet
19878
8e04817f
AC
19879Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19880present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19881step starting at that address.
c906108c 19882
ee2d5c50
AC
19883@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19884@cindex @code{I} packet
19885
19886@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19887
19888@item @code{j} --- reserved
19889
19890Reserved for future use.
19891
19892@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 19893
ee2d5c50 19894Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19895
ee2d5c50
AC
19896@item @code{k} --- kill request
19897@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 19898
ac282366 19899FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
19900thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19901thread?)}.
c906108c 19902
ee2d5c50 19903@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 19904
ee2d5c50
AC
19905Reserved for future use.
19906
19907@item @code{l} --- reserved
19908
19909Reserved for future use.
19910
19911@item @code{L} --- reserved
19912
19913Reserved for future use.
19914
19915@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19916@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 19917
8e04817f 19918Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 19919Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 19920assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 19921transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 19922
ee2d5c50
AC
19923Reply:
19924@table @samp
19925@item @var{XX@dots{}}
19926@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19927to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 19928that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
19929accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19930needed.}
19931@item E@var{NN}
19932@var{NN} is errno
19933@end table
19934
19935@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19936@cindex @code{M} packet
19937
8e04817f 19938Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19939@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19940
19941Reply:
19942@table @samp
19943@item OK
19944for success
19945@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
19946for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19947written).
ee2d5c50 19948@end table
c906108c 19949
ee2d5c50 19950@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 19951
ee2d5c50 19952Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19953
ee2d5c50 19954@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 19955
ee2d5c50 19956Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19957
ee2d5c50
AC
19958@item @code{o} --- reserved
19959
19960Reserved for future use.
19961
19962@item @code{O} --- reserved
19963
19964Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19965
ee2d5c50
AC
19966@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19967@cindex @code{p} packet
19968
19969@xref{write register packet}.
19970
19971Reply:
19972@table @samp
19973@item @var{r@dots{}.}
19974The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19975@end table
19976
19977@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19978@anchor{write register packet}
19979@cindex @code{P} packet
19980
19981Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 19982digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 19983
ee2d5c50
AC
19984Reply:
19985@table @samp
19986@item OK
19987for success
19988@item E@var{NN}
19989for an error
19990@end table
19991
19992@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19993@anchor{general query packet}
19994@cindex @code{q} packet
19995
19996Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19997leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19998prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19999be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
20000that they match the full @var{query} name.
20001
20002Reply:
20003@table @samp
20004@item @var{XX@dots{}}
20005Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
20006@item E@var{NN}
20007error reply
8e04817f 20008@item
ee2d5c50
AC
20009Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
20010@end table
20011
20012@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
20013@cindex @code{Q} packet
20014
20015Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
20016
20017@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 20018
ee2d5c50
AC
20019@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
20020@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 20021
8e04817f 20022Reset the entire system.
c906108c 20023
ee2d5c50
AC
20024@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
20025@cindex @code{R} packet
20026
8e04817f
AC
20027Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
20028This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
20029
20030Reply:
20031@table @samp
20032@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 20033The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
20034@end table
20035
20036@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
20037@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 20038
8e04817f
AC
20039@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
20040same address.
c906108c 20041
ee2d5c50
AC
20042Reply:
20043@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
20044
20045@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
20046@anchor{step with signal packet}
20047@cindex @code{S} packet
20048
8e04817f 20049Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 20050
ee2d5c50
AC
20051Reply:
20052@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
20053
b383017d 20054@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
ee2d5c50
AC
20055@cindex @code{t} packet
20056
8e04817f 20057Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
20058@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
20059@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 20060
ee2d5c50
AC
20061@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
20062@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 20063
ee2d5c50 20064Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 20065
ee2d5c50
AC
20066Reply:
20067@table @samp
20068@item OK
20069thread is still alive
20070@item E@var{NN}
20071thread is dead
20072@end table
20073
20074@item @code{u} --- reserved
20075
20076Reserved for future use.
20077
20078@item @code{U} --- reserved
20079
20080Reserved for future use.
20081
86d30acc 20082@item @code{v} --- verbose packet prefix
ee2d5c50 20083
86d30acc
DJ
20084Packets starting with @code{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
20085up to the first @code{;} or @code{?} (or the end of the packet).
20086
20087@item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}[@code{:}@var{tid}]]... --- extended resume
20088@cindex @code{vCont} packet
20089
20090Resume the inferior. Different actions may be specified for each thread.
20091If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
20092threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
20093specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
20094default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
20095Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
20096
20097@table @code
20098@item c
20099Continue.
20100@item C@var{sig}
20101Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
20102@item s
20103Step.
20104@item S@var{sig}
20105Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
20106@end table
20107
20108The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
20109not supported in @code{vCont}.
20110
20111Reply:
20112@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
20113
20114@item @code{vCont?} --- extended resume query
20115@cindex @code{vCont?} packet
20116
20117Query support for the @code{vCont} packet.
20118
20119Reply:
20120@table @samp
20121@item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}]...
20122The @code{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
20123command in the @code{vCont} packet.
20124@item
20125The @code{vCont} packet is not supported.
20126@end table
ee2d5c50
AC
20127
20128@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 20129
ee2d5c50 20130Reserved for future use.
c906108c 20131
ee2d5c50 20132@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 20133
ee2d5c50 20134Reserved for future use.
c906108c 20135
ee2d5c50 20136@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 20137
ee2d5c50 20138Reserved for future use.
c906108c 20139
ee2d5c50
AC
20140@item @code{x} --- reserved
20141
20142Reserved for future use.
20143
20144@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
20145@cindex @code{X} packet
20146
20147@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
20148is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 20149escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 20150
ee2d5c50
AC
20151Reply:
20152@table @samp
20153@item OK
20154for success
20155@item E@var{NN}
20156for an error
20157@end table
20158
20159@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 20160
ee2d5c50 20161Reserved for future use.
c906108c 20162
ee2d5c50
AC
20163@item @code{Y} reserved
20164
20165Reserved for future use.
20166
2f870471
AC
20167@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20168@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20169@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 20170@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 20171@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 20172
2f870471
AC
20173Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
20174watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
20175@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 20176
2f870471
AC
20177Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
20178separately.
20179
512217c7
AC
20180@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
20181for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
20182remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
20183@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
20184avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
20185be implemented in an idempotent way.}
20186
20187@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20188@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20189@cindex @code{z0} packet
20190@cindex @code{Z0} packet
20191
20192Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
20193@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20194
20195A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
20196@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
20197@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
20198breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
20199@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 20200
2f870471
AC
20201@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
20202code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
20203overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
20204target, is not defined.}
c906108c 20205
ee2d5c50
AC
20206Reply:
20207@table @samp
2f870471
AC
20208@item OK
20209success
20210@item
20211not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
20212@item E@var{NN}
20213for an error
2f870471
AC
20214@end table
20215
20216@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20217@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20218@cindex @code{z1} packet
20219@cindex @code{Z1} packet
20220
20221Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
20222address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20223
20224A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
20225dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
20226
20227@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
20228movement.}
20229
20230Reply:
20231@table @samp
ee2d5c50 20232@item OK
2f870471
AC
20233success
20234@item
20235not supported
20236@item E@var{NN}
20237for an error
20238@end table
20239
20240@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20241@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20242@cindex @code{z2} packet
20243@cindex @code{Z2} packet
20244
20245Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
20246
20247Reply:
20248@table @samp
20249@item OK
20250success
20251@item
20252not supported
20253@item E@var{NN}
20254for an error
20255@end table
20256
20257@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20258@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20259@cindex @code{z3} packet
20260@cindex @code{Z3} packet
20261
2e834e49 20262Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
20263
20264Reply:
20265@table @samp
20266@item OK
20267success
20268@item
20269not supported
20270@item E@var{NN}
20271for an error
20272@end table
20273
2e834e49
HPN
20274@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20275@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
20276@cindex @code{z4} packet
20277@cindex @code{Z4} packet
20278
20279Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20280
20281Reply:
20282@table @samp
20283@item OK
20284success
20285@item
20286not supported
20287@item E@var{NN}
20288for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
20289@end table
20290
20291@end table
c906108c 20292
ee2d5c50
AC
20293@node Stop Reply Packets
20294@section Stop Reply Packets
20295@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 20296
8e04817f
AC
20297The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20298receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20299@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20300when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20301number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20302conventions is used.
c906108c 20303
ee2d5c50 20304@table @samp
c906108c 20305
ee2d5c50
AC
20306@item S@var{AA}
20307@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 20308
8e04817f 20309@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
20310@cindex @code{T} packet reply
20311
8e04817f
AC
20312@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20313(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
12c266ea
AC
20314by @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread},
20315@var{r...} = thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} =
20316(@samp{watch} | @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data
20317address, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting
20318with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...},
20319@var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can extend the
20320protocol.
c906108c 20321
ee2d5c50
AC
20322@item W@var{AA}
20323
8e04817f 20324The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
20325applicable to certain targets.
20326
20327@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 20328
8e04817f 20329The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 20330
ee2d5c50 20331@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 20332
ee2d5c50
AC
20333@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20334any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20335to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20336
0ce1b118
CV
20337@item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20338
20339@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20340be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20341correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20342@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20343system calls.
20344
20345@var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20346system call.
20347
20348The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20349a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20350an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20351packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20352@samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20353@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20354
ee2d5c50
AC
20355@end table
20356
20357@node General Query Packets
20358@section General Query Packets
c906108c 20359
8e04817f 20360The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 20361
ee2d5c50 20362@table @r
c906108c 20363
ee2d5c50
AC
20364@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20365
20366Return the current thread id.
20367
20368Reply:
20369@table @samp
20370@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 20371Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
20372@item *
20373Any other reply implies the old pid.
20374@end table
20375
20376@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20377
20378@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 20379
8e04817f
AC
20380Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20381may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20382works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20383obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20384be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20385sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
20386
20387NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20388
20389Reply:
20390@table @samp
20391@item @code{m}@var{id}
20392A single thread id
20393@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20394a comma-separated list of thread ids
20395@item @code{l}
20396(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20397@end table
20398
20399In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20400more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20401will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
20402@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20403(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 20404
ee2d5c50
AC
20405@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20406
20407Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20408string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20409string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20410@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20411in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20412possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20413Mutex''.
20414
20415Reply:
20416@table @samp
20417@item @var{XX@dots{}}
20418Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20419the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 20420attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
20421@end table
20422
20423@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 20424
8e04817f
AC
20425Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20426digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20427subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20428number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20429(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20430returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
20431
20432NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20433(see above).
20434
20435Reply:
20436@table @samp
20437@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
20438Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20439returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20440and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
20441digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20442is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 20443digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 20444@end table
c906108c 20445
ee2d5c50
AC
20446@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20447
20448Reply:
20449@table @samp
20450@item @code{E}@var{NN}
20451An error (such as memory fault)
20452@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20453A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20454@end table
20455
20456@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 20457
8e04817f
AC
20458Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20459image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20460response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20461offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 20462
ee2d5c50
AC
20463Reply:
20464@table @samp
20465@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20466@end table
20467
20468@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20469
8e04817f
AC
20470Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20471encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
20472
20473Reply:
20474@table @samp
20475@item *
20476@end table
20477
8e04817f 20478See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 20479
ee2d5c50
AC
20480@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20481
20482@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
20483execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20484Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
20485number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20486@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20487interpreter may have security implications}.
20488
20489Reply:
20490@table @samp
20491@item OK
8e04817f 20492A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 20493@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 20494A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 20495@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 20496Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 20497@item @samp{}
8e04817f 20498When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
20499@end table
20500
20501@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 20502
8e04817f
AC
20503Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20504requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20505
20506Reply:
20507@table @samp
20508@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20509The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20510@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20511The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20512@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20513@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20514@end table
20515
20516@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20517
20518Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20519
20520@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20521target has previously requested.
20522
20523@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20524@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20525will be empty.
20526
20527Reply:
20528@table @samp
20529@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20530The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20531@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20532The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20533encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20534(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20535@end table
eb12ee30 20536
649e03f6
RM
20537@item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{read}:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} --- read special data
20538
20539Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
20540identified by the keyword @code{object}.
20541Request @var{length} bytes starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.
20542The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object;
20543it can supply additional details about what data to access.
20544
20545Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.
20546All @samp{@code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{read}:@dots{}}
20547requests use the same reply formats, listed below.
20548
20549@table @asis
20550@item @code{qPart}:@code{auxv}:@code{read}::@var{offset},@var{length}
20551Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{Auxiliary Vector}.
20552Note @var{annex} must be empty.
20553@end table
20554
20555Reply:
20556@table @asis
20557@item @code{OK}
20558The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
20559There is no more data to be read.
20560
20561@item @var{XX@dots{}}
20562Hex encoded data bytes read.
20563This may be fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
20564
20565@item @code{E00}
20566The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
20567
20568@item @code{E}@var{nn}
20569The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
20570@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
20571
20572@item @code{""} (empty)
20573An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
20574recognized by the stub.
20575@end table
20576
20577@item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{write}:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data@dots{}}
20578
20579Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
20580identified by the keyword @code{object},
20581starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.
20582@var{data@dots{}} is the hex-encoded data to be written.
20583The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object;
20584it can supply additional details about what data to access.
20585
20586No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
20587serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
20588specific request specifications ought to use.
20589
20590Reply:
20591@table @asis
20592@item @var{nn}
20593@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
20594This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
20595
20596@item @code{E00}
20597The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
20598
20599@item @code{E}@var{nn}
20600The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
20601@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
20602
20603@item @code{""} (empty)
20604An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
20605recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
20606@end table
20607
20608@item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
20609Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
20610not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
20611@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword,
20612the stub must respond with an empty packet.
ee2d5c50
AC
20613@end table
20614
20615@node Register Packet Format
20616@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 20617
8e04817f 20618The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
20619In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20620sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20621to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20622byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20623most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 20624
ee2d5c50 20625@table @r
eb12ee30 20626
8e04817f 20627@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 20628
8e04817f
AC
20629All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2063032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20631registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 20632
8e04817f 20633@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 20634
8e04817f
AC
20635All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20636thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20637as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 20638
ee2d5c50
AC
20639@end table
20640
20641@node Examples
20642@section Examples
eb12ee30 20643
8e04817f
AC
20644Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20645does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 20646
474c8240 20647@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
20648-> @code{R00}
20649<- @code{+}
8e04817f 20650@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 20651-> @code{?}
8e04817f 20652<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20653<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20654-> @code{+}
474c8240 20655@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20656
8e04817f 20657Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 20658
474c8240 20659@smallexample
d2c6833e 20660-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 20661<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20662-> @code{s}
20663<- @code{+}
20664@emph{time passes}
20665<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 20666-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 20667-> @code{g}
8e04817f 20668<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20669<- @code{1455@dots{}}
20670-> @code{+}
474c8240 20671@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20672
0ce1b118
CV
20673@node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20674@section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20675@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20676
20677@menu
20678* File-I/O Overview::
20679* Protocol basics::
1d8b2f28
JB
20680* The F request packet::
20681* The F reply packet::
0ce1b118
CV
20682* Memory transfer::
20683* The Ctrl-C message::
20684* Console I/O::
20685* The isatty call::
20686* The system call::
20687* List of supported calls::
20688* Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20689* Constants::
20690* File-I/O Examples::
20691@end menu
20692
20693@node File-I/O Overview
20694@subsection File-I/O Overview
20695@cindex file-i/o overview
20696
20697The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20698target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20699system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20700remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20701actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20702This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20703
20704The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20705it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20706@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20707translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20708when data is transmitted.
20709
20710The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20711when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20712packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20713the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20714memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20715is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20716
20717The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20718the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20719after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20720previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20721request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20722
20723@smallexample
20724(gdb) continue
20725 <- target requests 'system call X'
20726 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20727 -> GDB returns result
20728 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20729 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20730@end smallexample
20731
20732The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20733for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20734named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20735system are not supported by this protocol.
20736
20737@node Protocol basics
20738@subsection Protocol basics
20739@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20740
20741The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20742as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
b383017d 20743@value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
0ce1b118
CV
20744File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20745of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20746This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20747to call the appropriate host system call:
20748
20749@itemize @bullet
b383017d 20750@item
0ce1b118
CV
20751A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20752
20753@item
20754All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20755in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
b383017d 20756pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
0ce1b118
CV
20757Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20758
20759@end itemize
20760
20761At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20762
20763@itemize @bullet
b383017d 20764@item
0ce1b118
CV
20765If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20766to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20767standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20768expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20769packet.
20770
20771@item
20772@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20773representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20774
20775@item
20776@value{GDBN} calls the system call
20777
20778@item
20779It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20780
20781@item
20782If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20783a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20784target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20785by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20786packet.
20787
20788@end itemize
20789
20790Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20791necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20792
20793@itemize @bullet
20794@item
20795Return value.
20796
20797@item
20798@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20799
20800@item
20801``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20802
20803@end itemize
20804
20805After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20806the latest continue or step action.
20807
1d8b2f28 20808@node The F request packet
0ce1b118
CV
20809@subsection The @code{F} request packet
20810@cindex file-i/o request packet
20811@cindex @code{F} request packet
20812
20813The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20814
20815@table @samp
20816
20817@smallexample
20818@code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20819@end smallexample
20820
20821@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20822This is just the name of the function.
20823
20824@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20825
b383017d 20826@end table
0ce1b118
CV
20827
20828Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20829of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20830datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20831of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20832from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20833string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20834
1d8b2f28 20835@node The F reply packet
0ce1b118
CV
20836@subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20837@cindex file-i/o reply packet
20838@cindex @code{F} reply packet
20839
20840The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20841
20842@table @samp
20843
20844@smallexample
20845@code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20846@end smallexample
20847
20848@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20849
20850@var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20851This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20852
20853@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20854case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20855The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20856
20857@smallexample
20858F0,0,C
20859@end smallexample
20860
20861@noindent
20862or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20863
20864@smallexample
20865F-1,4,C
20866@end smallexample
20867
20868@noindent
20869assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20870
20871@end table
20872
20873@node Memory transfer
20874@subsection Memory transfer
20875@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20876
20877Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20878a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20879all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20880the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20881it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20882data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20883
20884@node The Ctrl-C message
20885@subsection The Ctrl-C message
20886@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20887
20888A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20889reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20890gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20891interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20892(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
b383017d 20893packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
0ce1b118
CV
20894state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20895not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20896
20897@itemize @bullet
20898@item
20899The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20900
20901@item
20902The system call on the host has been finished.
20903
20904@end itemize
20905
20906These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20907returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20908call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20909on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20910system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20911as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20912
20913@value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20914yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20915@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20916before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20917@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20918The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20919or the full action has been completed.
20920
20921@node Console I/O
20922@subsection Console I/O
20923@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20924
20925By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20926descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20927on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20928(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20929by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
209300 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20931conditions is met:
20932
20933@itemize @bullet
20934@item
20935The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20936@code{read}
20937system call is treated as finished.
20938
20939@item
20940The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20941line feed.
20942
20943@item
20944The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20945character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20946
20947@end itemize
20948
20949If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20950the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20951either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20952is stopped on users request.
20953
20954@node The isatty call
20955@subsection The isatty(3) call
20956@cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20957
20958A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20959is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
209601 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20961to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20962would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20963needed.
20964
20965@node The system call
20966@subsection The system(3) call
20967@cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20968
20969The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20970is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20971task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20972call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20973to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20974in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20975entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20976
20977Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
b383017d 20978by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
0ce1b118
CV
20979entering
20980
20981@table @samp
20982@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20983@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20984@end table
20985
20986Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20987
20988@table @samp
20989@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20990@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20991@end table
20992
20993The current setting is shown by typing
20994
20995@table @samp
20996@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20997@item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20998@end table
20999
21000@node List of supported calls
21001@subsection List of supported calls
21002@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
21003
21004@menu
21005* open::
21006* close::
21007* read::
21008* write::
21009* lseek::
21010* rename::
21011* unlink::
21012* stat/fstat::
21013* gettimeofday::
21014* isatty::
21015* system::
21016@end menu
21017
21018@node open
21019@unnumberedsubsubsec open
21020@cindex open, file-i/o system call
21021
21022@smallexample
21023@exdent Synopsis:
21024int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
21025int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
21026
b383017d 21027@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21028Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
21029@end smallexample
21030
21031@noindent
21032@code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
21033
21034@table @code
b383017d 21035@item O_CREAT
0ce1b118
CV
21036If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
21037rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
21038are concerned.
21039
b383017d 21040@item O_EXCL
0ce1b118
CV
21041When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
21042an error and open() fails.
21043
b383017d 21044@item O_TRUNC
0ce1b118
CV
21045If the file already exists and the open mode allows
21046writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
21047truncated to length 0.
21048
b383017d 21049@item O_APPEND
0ce1b118
CV
21050The file is opened in append mode.
21051
b383017d 21052@item O_RDONLY
0ce1b118
CV
21053The file is opened for reading only.
21054
b383017d 21055@item O_WRONLY
0ce1b118
CV
21056The file is opened for writing only.
21057
b383017d 21058@item O_RDWR
0ce1b118
CV
21059The file is opened for reading and writing.
21060
21061@noindent
21062Each other bit is silently ignored.
21063
21064@end table
21065
21066@noindent
21067@code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
21068
21069@table @code
b383017d 21070@item S_IRUSR
0ce1b118
CV
21071User has read permission.
21072
b383017d 21073@item S_IWUSR
0ce1b118
CV
21074User has write permission.
21075
b383017d 21076@item S_IRGRP
0ce1b118
CV
21077Group has read permission.
21078
b383017d 21079@item S_IWGRP
0ce1b118
CV
21080Group has write permission.
21081
b383017d 21082@item S_IROTH
0ce1b118
CV
21083Others have read permission.
21084
b383017d 21085@item S_IWOTH
0ce1b118
CV
21086Others have write permission.
21087
21088@noindent
21089Each other bit is silently ignored.
21090
21091@end table
21092
21093@smallexample
21094@exdent Return value:
21095open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
21096occured.
21097
21098@exdent Errors:
21099@end smallexample
21100
21101@table @code
b383017d 21102@item EEXIST
0ce1b118
CV
21103pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
21104
b383017d 21105@item EISDIR
0ce1b118
CV
21106pathname refers to a directory.
21107
b383017d 21108@item EACCES
0ce1b118
CV
21109The requested access is not allowed.
21110
21111@item ENAMETOOLONG
21112pathname was too long.
21113
b383017d 21114@item ENOENT
0ce1b118
CV
21115A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21116
b383017d 21117@item ENODEV
0ce1b118
CV
21118pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
21119
b383017d 21120@item EROFS
0ce1b118
CV
21121pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
21122write access was requested.
21123
b383017d 21124@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21125pathname is an invalid pointer value.
21126
b383017d 21127@item ENOSPC
0ce1b118
CV
21128No space on device to create the file.
21129
b383017d 21130@item EMFILE
0ce1b118
CV
21131The process already has the maximum number of files open.
21132
b383017d 21133@item ENFILE
0ce1b118
CV
21134The limit on the total number of files open on the system
21135has been reached.
21136
b383017d 21137@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21138The call was interrupted by the user.
21139@end table
21140
21141@node close
21142@unnumberedsubsubsec close
21143@cindex close, file-i/o system call
21144
21145@smallexample
b383017d 21146@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21147int close(int fd);
21148
b383017d 21149@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21150Fclose,fd
21151
21152@exdent Return value:
21153close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
21154
21155@exdent Errors:
21156@end smallexample
21157
21158@table @code
b383017d 21159@item EBADF
0ce1b118
CV
21160fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
21161
b383017d 21162@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21163The call was interrupted by the user.
21164@end table
21165
21166@node read
21167@unnumberedsubsubsec read
21168@cindex read, file-i/o system call
21169
21170@smallexample
b383017d 21171@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21172int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
21173
b383017d 21174@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21175Fread,fd,bufptr,count
21176
21177@exdent Return value:
21178On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
21179Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
b383017d 21180returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
0ce1b118
CV
21181
21182@exdent Errors:
21183@end smallexample
21184
21185@table @code
b383017d 21186@item EBADF
0ce1b118
CV
21187fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
21188reading.
21189
b383017d 21190@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21191buf is an invalid pointer value.
21192
b383017d 21193@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21194The call was interrupted by the user.
21195@end table
21196
21197@node write
21198@unnumberedsubsubsec write
21199@cindex write, file-i/o system call
21200
21201@smallexample
b383017d 21202@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21203int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
21204
b383017d 21205@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21206Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
21207
21208@exdent Return value:
21209On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
21210Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
21211is returned.
21212
21213@exdent Errors:
21214@end smallexample
21215
21216@table @code
b383017d 21217@item EBADF
0ce1b118
CV
21218fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
21219writing.
21220
b383017d 21221@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21222buf is an invalid pointer value.
21223
b383017d 21224@item EFBIG
0ce1b118
CV
21225An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
21226host specific maximum file size allowed.
21227
b383017d 21228@item ENOSPC
0ce1b118
CV
21229No space on device to write the data.
21230
b383017d 21231@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21232The call was interrupted by the user.
21233@end table
21234
21235@node lseek
21236@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
21237@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
21238
21239@smallexample
b383017d 21240@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21241long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
21242
b383017d 21243@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21244Flseek,fd,offset,flag
21245@end smallexample
21246
21247@code{flag} is one of:
21248
21249@table @code
b383017d 21250@item SEEK_SET
0ce1b118
CV
21251The offset is set to offset bytes.
21252
b383017d 21253@item SEEK_CUR
0ce1b118
CV
21254The offset is set to its current location plus offset
21255bytes.
21256
b383017d 21257@item SEEK_END
0ce1b118
CV
21258The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
21259bytes.
21260@end table
21261
21262@smallexample
21263@exdent Return value:
21264On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
21265the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
21266value of -1 is returned.
21267
21268@exdent Errors:
21269@end smallexample
21270
21271@table @code
b383017d 21272@item EBADF
0ce1b118
CV
21273fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
21274
b383017d 21275@item ESPIPE
0ce1b118
CV
21276fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
21277
b383017d 21278@item EINVAL
0ce1b118
CV
21279flag is not a proper value.
21280
b383017d 21281@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21282The call was interrupted by the user.
21283@end table
21284
21285@node rename
21286@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
21287@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
21288
21289@smallexample
b383017d 21290@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21291int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
21292
b383017d 21293@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21294Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
21295
21296@exdent Return value:
21297On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21298
21299@exdent Errors:
21300@end smallexample
21301
21302@table @code
b383017d 21303@item EISDIR
0ce1b118
CV
21304newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
21305directory.
21306
b383017d 21307@item EEXIST
0ce1b118
CV
21308newpath is a non-empty directory.
21309
b383017d 21310@item EBUSY
0ce1b118
CV
21311oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
21312process.
21313
b383017d 21314@item EINVAL
0ce1b118
CV
21315An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
21316of itself.
21317
b383017d 21318@item ENOTDIR
0ce1b118
CV
21319A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
21320path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
21321and newpath exists but is not a directory.
21322
b383017d 21323@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21324oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
21325
b383017d 21326@item EACCES
0ce1b118
CV
21327No access to the file or the path of the file.
21328
21329@item ENAMETOOLONG
b383017d 21330
0ce1b118
CV
21331oldpath or newpath was too long.
21332
b383017d 21333@item ENOENT
0ce1b118
CV
21334A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
21335
b383017d 21336@item EROFS
0ce1b118
CV
21337The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21338
b383017d 21339@item ENOSPC
0ce1b118
CV
21340The device containing the file has no room for the new
21341directory entry.
21342
b383017d 21343@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21344The call was interrupted by the user.
21345@end table
21346
21347@node unlink
21348@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21349@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21350
21351@smallexample
b383017d 21352@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21353int unlink(const char *pathname);
21354
b383017d 21355@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21356Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21357
21358@exdent Return value:
21359On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21360
21361@exdent Errors:
21362@end smallexample
21363
21364@table @code
b383017d 21365@item EACCES
0ce1b118
CV
21366No access to the file or the path of the file.
21367
b383017d 21368@item EPERM
0ce1b118
CV
21369The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21370
b383017d 21371@item EBUSY
0ce1b118
CV
21372The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21373being used by another process.
21374
b383017d 21375@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21376pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21377
21378@item ENAMETOOLONG
21379pathname was too long.
21380
b383017d 21381@item ENOENT
0ce1b118
CV
21382A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21383
b383017d 21384@item ENOTDIR
0ce1b118
CV
21385A component of the path is not a directory.
21386
b383017d 21387@item EROFS
0ce1b118
CV
21388The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21389
b383017d 21390@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21391The call was interrupted by the user.
21392@end table
21393
21394@node stat/fstat
21395@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21396@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21397@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21398
21399@smallexample
b383017d 21400@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21401int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21402int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21403
b383017d 21404@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21405Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21406Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21407
21408@exdent Return value:
21409On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21410
21411@exdent Errors:
21412@end smallexample
21413
21414@table @code
b383017d 21415@item EBADF
0ce1b118
CV
21416fd is not a valid open file.
21417
b383017d 21418@item ENOENT
0ce1b118
CV
21419A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21420path is an empty string.
21421
b383017d 21422@item ENOTDIR
0ce1b118
CV
21423A component of the path is not a directory.
21424
b383017d 21425@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21426pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21427
b383017d 21428@item EACCES
0ce1b118
CV
21429No access to the file or the path of the file.
21430
21431@item ENAMETOOLONG
21432pathname was too long.
21433
b383017d 21434@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21435The call was interrupted by the user.
21436@end table
21437
21438@node gettimeofday
21439@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21440@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21441
21442@smallexample
b383017d 21443@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21444int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21445
b383017d 21446@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21447Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21448
21449@exdent Return value:
21450On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21451
21452@exdent Errors:
21453@end smallexample
21454
21455@table @code
b383017d 21456@item EINVAL
0ce1b118
CV
21457tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21458
b383017d 21459@item EFAULT
0ce1b118
CV
21460tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21461@end table
21462
21463@node isatty
21464@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21465@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21466
21467@smallexample
b383017d 21468@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21469int isatty(int fd);
21470
b383017d 21471@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21472Fisatty,fd
21473
21474@exdent Return value:
21475Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21476
21477@exdent Errors:
21478@end smallexample
21479
21480@table @code
b383017d 21481@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21482The call was interrupted by the user.
21483@end table
21484
21485@node system
21486@unnumberedsubsubsec system
21487@cindex system, file-i/o system call
21488
21489@smallexample
b383017d 21490@exdent Synopsis:
0ce1b118
CV
21491int system(const char *command);
21492
b383017d 21493@exdent Request:
0ce1b118
CV
21494Fsystem,commandptr/len
21495
21496@exdent Return value:
21497The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21498of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21499command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21500system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21501In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21502
21503@exdent Errors:
21504@end smallexample
21505
21506@table @code
b383017d 21507@item EINTR
0ce1b118
CV
21508The call was interrupted by the user.
21509@end table
21510
21511@node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21512@subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21513@cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21514
21515@menu
21516* Integral datatypes::
21517* Pointer values::
21518* struct stat::
21519* struct timeval::
21520@end menu
21521
21522@node Integral datatypes
21523@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21524@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21525
21526The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21527
21528@smallexample
21529int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21530@end smallexample
21531
21532@code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21533implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21534
b383017d
RM
21535@code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21536
0ce1b118
CV
21537@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21538in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21539
21540@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21541
21542All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21543structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21544byte order.
21545
21546@node Pointer values
21547@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21548@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21549
21550Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21551is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21552transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21553are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21554
21555@smallexample
21556@code{1aaf/12}
21557@end smallexample
21558
21559@noindent
21560which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21561The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21562the trailing null byte. Example:
21563
21564@smallexample
21565``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21566@end smallexample
21567
21568@noindent
21569is transmitted as
21570
21571@smallexample
21572@code{123456/d}
21573@end smallexample
21574
21575@node struct stat
21576@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21577@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21578
21579The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21580as follows:
21581
21582@smallexample
21583struct stat @{
21584 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21585 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21586 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21587 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21588 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21589 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21590 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21591 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21592 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21593 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21594 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21595 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21596 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21597@};
21598@end smallexample
21599
21600The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21601approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21602structure is of size 64 bytes.
21603
21604The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21605range of values.
21606
21607@smallexample
21608st_dev: 0 file
21609 1 console
21610
21611st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21612
21613st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21614 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21615
21616st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21617
21618st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21619
21620st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21621
21622st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21623 These values have a host and file system dependent
21624 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21625 don't support exact timing values.
21626@end smallexample
21627
21628The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21629responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21630continuing.
21631
21632Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21633representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21634get truncated on the target.
21635
21636@node struct timeval
21637@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21638@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21639
21640The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21641is defined as follows:
21642
21643@smallexample
b383017d 21644struct timeval @{
0ce1b118
CV
21645 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21646 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21647@};
21648@end smallexample
21649
21650The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21651approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21652structure is of size 8 bytes.
21653
21654@node Constants
21655@subsection Constants
21656@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21657
21658The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21659protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21660values before and after the call as needed.
21661
21662@menu
21663* Open flags::
21664* mode_t values::
21665* Errno values::
21666* Lseek flags::
21667* Limits::
21668@end menu
21669
21670@node Open flags
21671@unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21672@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21673
21674All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21675
21676@smallexample
21677 O_RDONLY 0x0
21678 O_WRONLY 0x1
21679 O_RDWR 0x2
21680 O_APPEND 0x8
21681 O_CREAT 0x200
21682 O_TRUNC 0x400
21683 O_EXCL 0x800
21684@end smallexample
21685
21686@node mode_t values
21687@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21688@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21689
21690All values are given in octal representation.
21691
21692@smallexample
21693 S_IFREG 0100000
21694 S_IFDIR 040000
21695 S_IRUSR 0400
21696 S_IWUSR 0200
21697 S_IXUSR 0100
21698 S_IRGRP 040
21699 S_IWGRP 020
21700 S_IXGRP 010
21701 S_IROTH 04
21702 S_IWOTH 02
21703 S_IXOTH 01
21704@end smallexample
21705
21706@node Errno values
21707@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21708@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21709
21710All values are given in decimal representation.
21711
21712@smallexample
21713 EPERM 1
21714 ENOENT 2
21715 EINTR 4
21716 EBADF 9
21717 EACCES 13
21718 EFAULT 14
21719 EBUSY 16
21720 EEXIST 17
21721 ENODEV 19
21722 ENOTDIR 20
21723 EISDIR 21
21724 EINVAL 22
21725 ENFILE 23
21726 EMFILE 24
21727 EFBIG 27
21728 ENOSPC 28
21729 ESPIPE 29
21730 EROFS 30
21731 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21732 EUNKNOWN 9999
21733@end smallexample
21734
21735 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21736 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21737
21738@node Lseek flags
21739@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21740@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21741
21742@smallexample
21743 SEEK_SET 0
21744 SEEK_CUR 1
21745 SEEK_END 2
21746@end smallexample
21747
21748@node Limits
21749@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21750@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21751
21752All values are given in decimal representation.
21753
21754@smallexample
21755 INT_MIN -2147483648
21756 INT_MAX 2147483647
21757 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21758 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21759 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21760 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21761@end smallexample
21762
21763@node File-I/O Examples
21764@subsection File-I/O Examples
21765@cindex file-i/o examples
21766
21767Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21768address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21769
21770@smallexample
21771<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21772@emph{request memory read from target}
21773-> @code{m1234,6}
21774<- XXXXXX
21775@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21776-> @code{F6}
21777@end smallexample
21778
21779Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21780address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21781
21782@smallexample
21783<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21784@emph{request memory write to target}
21785-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21786@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21787-> @code{F6}
21788@end smallexample
21789
21790Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21791file descriptor (EBADF):
21792
21793@smallexample
21794<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21795-> @code{F-1,9}
21796@end smallexample
21797
21798Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21799host is called:
21800
21801@smallexample
21802<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21803-> @code{F-1,4,C}
21804<- @code{T02}
21805@end smallexample
21806
21807Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21808host is called:
21809
21810@smallexample
21811<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21812-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21813<- @code{T02}
21814@end smallexample
21815
f418dd93
DJ
21816@include agentexpr.texi
21817
aab4e0ec 21818@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 21819
2154891a 21820@raisesections
6826cf00 21821@include fdl.texi
2154891a 21822@lowersections
6826cf00 21823
6d2ebf8b 21824@node Index
c906108c
SS
21825@unnumbered Index
21826
21827@printindex cp
21828
21829@tex
21830% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21831% meantime:
21832\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21833\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21834\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21835\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21836\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21837\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21838\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21839\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21840\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21841\page\colophon
21842% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21843@end tex
21844
c906108c 21845@bye
This page took 1.726633 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.